Honeywell Smoke Alarm MS 9600LS User Manual

Addressable Fire Alarm Control Panel  
MS-9600LS/MS-9600LSE  
MS-9600UDLS/MS-9600UDLSE  
MS-9600LSC  
Manual  
Document 52646  
2/12/2010  
P/N 52646:B2  
Rev:  
B2  
ECN 10-098  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation Precautions  
Adherence to the following will aid in problem-free installation with long-term reliability:  
WARNING - Several different sources of power can be  
connected to the fire alarm control panel. Disconnect all  
sources of power before servicing. Control unit and associ-  
ated equipment may be damaged by removing and/or insert-  
ing cards, modules, or interconnecting cables while the unit is  
energized. Do not attempt to install, service, or operate this  
unit until manuals are read and understood.  
Like all solid state electronic devices, this system may  
operate erratically or can be damaged when subjected to light-  
ning induced transients. Although no system is completely  
immune from lightning transients and interference, proper  
grounding will reduce susceptibility. Overhead or outside aerial  
wiring is not recommended, due to an increased susceptibility  
to nearby lightning strikes. Consult with the Technical Ser-  
vices Department if any problems are anticipated or encoun-  
tered.  
CAUTION - System Re-acceptance Test after Software  
Changes: To ensure proper system operation, this product  
must be tested in accordance with NFPA 72 after any pro-  
gramming operation or change in site-specific software. Re-  
acceptance testing is required after any change, addition or  
deletion of system components, or after any modification,  
repair or adjustment to system hardware or wiring. All compo-  
nents, circuits, system operations, or software functions known  
to be affected by a change must be 100% tested. In addition,  
to ensure that other operations are not inadvertently affected,  
at least 10% of initiating devices that are not directly affected  
by the change, up to a maximum of 50 devices, must also be  
tested and proper system operation verified.  
Disconnect AC power and batteries prior to removing or  
inserting circuit boards. Failure to do so can damage circuits.  
Remove all electronic assemblies prior to any drilling, filing,  
reaming, or punching of the enclosure. When possible, make  
all cable entries from the sides or rear. Before making modifi-  
cations, verify that they will not interfere with battery, trans-  
former, or printed circuit board location.  
Do not tighten screw terminals more than 9 in-lbs. Over-  
tightening may damage threads, resulting in reduced terminal  
contact pressure and difficulty with screw terminal removal.  
This system contains static-sensitive components.  
Always ground yourself with a proper wrist strap before han-  
dling any circuits so that static charges are removed from the  
body. Use static suppressive packaging to protect electronic  
assemblies removed from the unit.  
This system meets NFPA requirements for operation at 0-49º  
C/32-120º F and at a relative humidity 93% ± 2% RH (non-  
condensing) at 32°C ± 2°C (90°F ± 3°F). However, the useful  
life of the system's standby batteries and the electronic com-  
ponents may be adversely affected by extreme temperature  
ranges and humidity. Therefore, it is recommended that this  
system and its peripherals be installed in an environment with  
a normal room temperature of 15-27º C/60-80º F.  
Follow the instructions in the installation, operating, and pro-  
gramming manuals. These instructions must be followed to  
avoid damage to the control panel and associated equipment.  
FACP operation and reliability depend upon proper installation.  
Verify that wire sizes are adequate for all initiating and indi-  
cating device loops. Most devices cannot tolerate more than a  
10% I.R. drop from the specified device voltage.  
Precau-D1-9-2005  
FCC Warning  
WARNING: This equipment generates, uses, and can  
radiate radio frequency energy and if not installed and  
used in accordance with the instruction manual may  
cause interference to radio communications. It has been  
tested and found to comply with the limits for class A  
computing devices pursuant to Subpart B of Part 15 of  
FCC Rules, which is designed to provide reasonable  
protection against such interference when devices are  
operated in a commercial environment. Operation of this  
equipment in a residential area is likely to cause interfer-  
ence, in which case the user will be required to correct  
the interference at his or her own expense.  
Canadian Requirements  
This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class A limits  
for radiation noise emissions from digital apparatus set  
out in the Radio Interference Regulations of the Cana-  
dian Department of Communications.  
Le present appareil numerique n'emet pas de bruits  
radioelectriques depassant les limites applicables aux  
appareils numeriques de la classe A prescrites dans le  
Reglement sur le brouillage radioelectrique edicte par le  
ministere des Communications du Canada.  
LiteSpeed™ is a trademark; and FireLite® Alarms is a registered trademark of Honeywell International Inc. Microsoft® and Windows® are registered  
trademarks of the Microsoft Corporation.  
©Tuesday, August 14, 2012 9:31 am by Honeywell International Inc. All rights reserved. Unauthorized use of this document is strictly prohibited.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Software Downloads  
In order to supply the latest features and functionality in fire alarm and life safety technology to our customers, we make  
frequent upgrades to the embedded software in our products. To ensure that you are installing and programming the latest  
features, we strongly recommend that you download the most current version of software for each product prior to  
commissioning any system. Contact Technical Support with any questions about software and the appropriate version for  
a specific application.  
Documentation Feedback  
Your feedback helps us keep our documentation up-to-date and accurate. If you have any comments or suggestions about  
our online Help or printed manuals, you can email us.  
Please include the following information:  
•Product name and version number (if applicable)  
•Printed manual or online Help  
•Topic Title (for online Help)  
•Page number (for printed manual)  
•Brief description of content you think should be improved or corrected  
Your suggestion for how to correct/improve documentation  
Send email messages to:  
Please note this email address is for documentation feedback only. If you have any technical issues, please contact  
Technical Services.  
4
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
6
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
8
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
It is imperative that the installer understand the requirements of the Authority Having Jurisdiction  
(AHJ) and be familiar with the standards set forth by the following regulatory agencies:  
Underwriters Laboratories Standards  
NFPA 72 National Fire Alarm Code  
CAN/ULC - S527-99 Standard for Control Units for Fire Alarm Systems  
Before proceeding, the installer should be familiar with the following documents.  
NFPA Standards  
NFPA 72 National Fire Alarm Code  
NFPA 70 National Electrical Code  
Underwriters Laboratories Documents:  
UL 38 Manually Actuated Signaling Boxes  
UL 217 Smoke Detectors, Single and Multiple Station  
UL 228 Door Closers–Holders for Fire Protective Signaling Systems  
UL 268 Smoke Detectors for Fire Protective Signaling Systems  
UL 268A Smoke Detectors for Duct Applications  
UL 346 Waterflow Indicators for Fire Protective Signaling Systems  
UL 464 Audible Signaling Appliances  
UL 521 Heat Detectors for Fire Protective Signaling Systems  
ANSI/UL 864, Control Units and Accessories for Fire Alarm Systems  
UL 1481 Power Supplies for Fire Protective Signaling Systems  
UL 1610 Central Station Burglar Alarm Units  
UL 1638 Visual Signaling Appliances  
UL 1971 Signaling Devices for Hearing Impaired  
UL 2017 General-Purpose Signaling Devices and System  
CAN/ULC - S524-01 Standard for Installation of Fire Alarm Systems  
CAN/ULC - S527-99 Standard for Control Units for Fire Alarm Systems  
CAN\ULC - S559-04 Equipment for Fire Signal Receiving Centers and Systems  
CAN\ULC - S561-03 Installation and Services for Fire Signal Receiving Centers and Systems  
Note: MS-9600LSE/MS-9600UDLSE is not ULC listed for Canadian applications  
This Class (A) digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe (A) est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
FM Approved to ANSI/UL 864  
Other:  
EIA-232E Serial Interface Standard  
EIA-485 Serial Interface Standard  
NEC Article 250 Grounding  
NEC Article 300 Wiring Methods  
NEC Article 760 Fire Protective Signaling Systems  
Applicable Local and State Building Codes  
Requirements of the Local Authority Having Jurisdiction (LAHJ)  
Fire-Lite Documents:  
Fire-Lite Device Compatibility  
SLC Wiring Manual  
Document #15384  
Document #51309  
Document #51480  
Document #50759  
Document #51073  
Document #50888  
Document #51315  
Document #50055  
Document #51338  
Document #50362  
Document #53037  
Document #53109  
Document #52749  
Document #53032  
Document #151416  
Document #53033  
Document #151417  
Document #51889  
ACS Series Annunciators  
411UD Communicator/Transmitter  
411UDAC Communicator/Transmitter  
CHG-120F Battery Charger  
CHG-75 Battery Charger  
LDM Series Lamp Driver Modules  
LCD-80F Remote Fire Annunciator  
ACM-8RF Relay Control Module  
DACT-UD2 Manual  
IDACT Communicator/Transmitter  
ANN-80 Installation Document  
ANN-(R)LED Installation Document  
ANN-I/O Installation Document  
ANN-RLY Installation Document  
ANN-S/PG Installation Document  
ACC-25/50(ZS/T) Manual  
This product has been certified to comply with the requirements in the ANSI/UL 864, Standard for Control  
Units and Accessories for Fire Alarm Systems, 9th Edition. Operation of this product with products not tested  
for ANSI/UL 864, 9th Edition has not been evaluated. Such operation requires the approval of the local  
Authority Having Jurisdiction (AHJ).  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Peripheral Devices and Their Documents:  
Audio Control for ACC-25/50(ZS/T) Audio-Command-Center Doc. #51889  
ANN-(R)LED  
LED Display  
Doc. #53032  
ANN-I/O  
LED Driver  
Doc. #151416  
ANN-80  
Text Annunciator  
Doc. #52749  
ANN-S/PG  
Printer Driver  
Doc. #151417  
ANN-RLY  
Form-C Relay Card  
Doc. #53033  
IPDACT  
Internet Communicator  
Doc. # 53109  
ANN (EIA-485) TB6  
DACT-UD2  
Communicator  
Doc. # 53037  
J2 Connector  
4XTMF  
Reverse Polarity  
module  
J10, J11 Connectors  
SLC Loop  
Addressable Devices and SLC Wiring  
Doc. # 51309  
Battery Connector TB2  
CHG-75 Charger  
Doc. # 51315  
CHG-120F Charger  
Doc. # 50888  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes  
12  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1: Product Description  
The MS-9600LS and MS-9600UDLS are compact, cost effective, intelligent addressable FACPs  
(Fire Alarm Control Panels) with an extensive list of powerful features. The combination of  
Fire•Lite’s newer series devices and legacy 300 Series devices, along with the MS-9600LS or MS-  
9600UDLS FACP, offer the latest in fire protection technology. The FLPS-7 power supply is a sep-  
arate board while all other electronics are contained on a single main circuit board. Both boards are  
mounted to a chassis and housed in a metal cabinet, providing a complete fire control system for  
most applications. Optional modules, which plug into the main circuit board, are available for spe-  
cial functions. Available accessories include LED, graphic and LCD annunciators, reverse polar-  
ity/city box transmitter, digital alarm communicator/transmitter, SLC expansion module, local and  
remote upload/download software and remote power expansion.  
The MS-9600UDLS includes a factory installed DACT-UD2 Digital Alarm Communicator Trans-  
mitter. Refer to “DACT-UD2 Installation” on page 52 and to the DACT-UD2 Manual Document  
#53037, which is supplied with the FACP, for DACT wiring and programming information. The  
DACT transmits system status (alarm, troubles, AC loss, etc.) to a Central Station via the public  
switched telephone network. It also allows remote programming or interrogation of the control  
panel using the PS-Tools Upload/Download utility via the public switched telephone network.  
Local programming and interrogation is also possible for the MS-9600UDLS using the PS-Tools  
and the USB port J4 on the DACT-UD2. The MS-9600LS can be programmed and interrogated  
locally using the serial port at TB7. Any personal computer with Windows® XP or greater and  
compatible modem with a speed of 2400 baud or faster and PS-Tools software may serve as a Ser-  
vice Terminal. This allows download of the entire program or upload of the entire program, history  
file, walktest data, current status and system voltages.  
The MS-9600LSC is a ULC approved Canadian version of the FACP which offers the same fea-  
tures as the MS-9600LS, but is supplied standard with a DP-9692 dress panel. Refer to “Canadian  
Option” on page 113 for a full description.  
The MS-9600LSE and MS-9600UDLSE offer the same features as the MS-9600LS and MS-  
9600UDLS but allow connection to 220/240 VAC input.  
NOTE: Unless otherwise specified, the terms FACP, MS-9600LS and MS-9600UDLS are used  
in this manual to refer to all versions of the FACPs.  
1.1 Inventory  
When the FACP shipment is received, check to make certain that all parts have been included in the  
shipment. The FACP shipment should consist of one of each of the following:  
main circuit board with display  
FLPS-7 Power Supply  
chassis (with main circuit board and power supply mounted)  
backbox with door and dress panel  
plastic bag containing screws, cables, key, etc.  
manual  
1.2 Features and Options  
New LiteSpeed™ polling protocol for faster SLC response time  
SLC operates up to 10,000 ft. (3,000 m) in LiteSpeed mode with twisted, unshielded wire or  
3,000 ft (900 m) with untwisted, unshielded wire  
Single standard addressable SLC loop which meets NFPA Style 4, 6 and 7 requirements  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Product Description  
Features and Options  
Optional module for adding a second SLC loop which meets NFPA Style 4, 6 and 7  
requirements  
318 addressable device capacity for each SLC loop (159 detectors and 159 control/monitor  
modules)  
99 software zones  
Up to four onboard NACs (Notification Appliance Circuits):  
four Style Y (Class B) or two Style Z (Class A)  
Additional NAC capability using control modules  
7.0 amps total power for NACs and 24 VDC auxiliary power outputs in alarm  
Two programmable relay outputs and one fixed trouble relay  
EIA-232 Printer/PC interface (variable baud rate)  
80-character LCD display (backlit)  
Real-time clock/calendar with daylight savings time control  
History file with 1,000 event capacity  
Advanced fire technology features:  
• Automatic drift compensation  
• Maintenance alert  
• Detector sensitivity test capability (NFPA 72 compliant)  
• Automatic device type-code verification  
• Point trouble identification  
Waterflow selection per module point  
Alarm verification selection per detector point  
Walktest, silent or audible  
PAS (Positive Alarm Sequence) and Pre-signal per point (NFPA 72 compliant)  
New ANN-BUS Annunciators/Modules (ACS annunciators cannot be used when ANN-BUS  
annunciators/modules are connected)  
• ANN-80 Remote Liquid Crystal Display point annunciator  
• ANN-I/O LED Driver Module  
• ANN-LED Alarm, Trouble, Supervisory Annunciator (minimum of one required for  
Canadian applications)  
• ANN-RLED Alarm Annunciator  
• ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel Printer Module  
• ANN-RLY Form-C Relay Module  
• Automated activation of the ACC-25/50(ZS/T) Audio-Command-Center  
Legacy ACS/Term Annunciators: (ANN-BUS annunciator/modules cannot be used when  
ACS/Term annunciators are connected)  
• ACM Series-LED Zone Annunciators  
• LDM Graphic Annunciator Series  
• LCD-80F Liquid Crystal Display point annunciator (LCD-80FC for Canadian applications)  
• ACM-8RF Relay Module  
Silence inhibit timer option per NAC  
Autosilence timer option per NAC  
Continuous, March Time, Temporal or California code for main circuit board NACs with two-  
stage capability  
Selectable strobe synchronization per NAC  
Remote Acknowledge, Alarm Silence, Reset and Drill via addressable modules, legacy ACS  
annunciators or ANN-80 Remote annunciator  
14  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                                       
Specifications  
Product Description  
Auto-program (learn mode) reduces installation time. Reports two devices set to the same  
address  
Password and key-protected nonvolatile memory  
User programmable password  
Fully programmable from local keypad or keyboard or local PC  
Compatible with Fire•Lite’s newer series addressable devices (LiteSpeed and CLIP Mode) -  
Refer to SLC Wiring Manual for listing of all compatible addressable devices  
Compatible with legacy Fire•Lite’s 300 Series devices (CLIP Mode only) - Refer to SLC  
Wiring Manual for listing of all compatible addressable devices  
Optional 4XTMF module (conventional reverse polarity/city box transmitter)  
Optional DACT-UD2 Digital Alarm Communicator Transmitter, reports up to 99 zones or 636  
points (all devices) to a UL listed Central Station. The DACT-UD2 is supplied standard with  
the MS-9600UDLS/E  
Optional PK-CD (contains PS-Tools utility) for local or remote Upload/Download of program  
and data.  
Optional DP-9692 dress panel (required for Canadian applications)  
1.3 Specifications  
AC Power - TB1 of Power Supply Board  
MS-9600LS(C) & MS-9600UDLS: 120 VAC, 50/60 Hz, 3.0 amps (L1=Hot, L2=Neutral)  
MS-9600LSE & MS-9600UDLSE: 240 VAC, 50 Hz, 1.5 amps (L1=Hot Leg 1, L2=Hot Leg 2)  
Wire size: minimum 14 AWG (2.00 mm2) with 600 V insulation  
Battery (Sealed Lead Acid Only) - TB2  
Maximum Charging Circuit: Normal Flat Charge - 27.6 VDC @ 1.00 amp  
Maximum Battery Size: 26 Amp Hour  
Minimum Battery Size: 12 Amp Hour  
(FACP cabinet holds maximum of two 18 Amp Hour batteries. For greater than 18 Amp Hour up  
to 26 Amp Hour batteries, use BB26 Battery Box)  
For greater than 26 Amp Hour up to 75 Amp Hour batteries, use the CHG-75 Battery Charger and  
BB26 or BB-55F Battery Box. For greater than 75 Amp Hour up to 120 Amp Hour batteries, use  
the CHG-120F Battery Charger and BB-55F Battery Box.  
Jumper JP3, on the FACP main circuit board, must be removed to disable the FACP battery char-  
ger when using the CHG-75 or CHG-120F.  
Communication Loop - (Standard ) TB8 and (Optional SLC Expander Module) J3  
24 VDC nominal, 27.6 VDC maximum  
Maximum loop current is 400 mA (short circuit) or 100 mA (normal)  
Maximum loop resistance is 40 ohms  
Supervised and power-limited  
Refer to SLC Wiring Manual for wiring information  
NOTE: When installing SLC wiring in conduit, each loop must be installed in separate conduit.  
Notification Appliance Circuits - TB4  
Special Application power  
Power-limited circuitry, supervised  
Nominal operating voltage: 24 VDC  
Current-limit: fuseless, electronic, power-limited circuitry  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                       
Product Description  
Specifications  
Maximum signaling current per circuit: 3.00 amps (see Figure 1.1 on page 17)  
End-of-Line Resistor: 4.7 k, ½ watt (P/N 71252 UL listed) for NACs  
Refer to Device Compatibility Document for listed compatible devices  
Two Programmable and One Fixed Output Relay - TB1 & TB5  
Contact rating: 2.0 amps @ 30 VDC (resistive), 0.5 amps @ 30 VAC (resistive)  
Form-C relays  
Refer to Figure 2.5 on page 47 for information on power-limited wiring for relay circuits  
Four-Wire Resettable Special Application Smoke Detector Power (24 VDC nominal) -  
TB3, Terminals 1 (+) & 2 (-)  
Maximum ripple voltage: 10 mVRMS  
Up to 1.5 amps is available for powering 4-wire smoke detectors (see Figure 1.1)  
Power-limited circuit, nonsupervised  
Refer to Device Compatibility Document for listed compatible devices  
Nonresettable Special Application Power #1 (24 VDC Nominal) -  
TB3, Terminals 3 (+) & 4 (-)  
Maximum ripple voltage: 10mVRMS  
Total DC current available from each output is up to 1.5 amps (see Figure 1.1)  
Power-limited circuit, nonsupervised  
Nonresettable Special Application Power #2 (24 VDC Nominal) -  
TB3, Terminals 5 (+) & 6 (-)  
Maximum ripple voltage: 10mVRMS  
Total DC current available from each output is up to 1.5 amps (see Figure 1.1)  
Power-limited circuit, nonsupervised  
EIA-485 (ACS/ANN-BUS) - TB6  
ACS/ANN annunciator connector, Terminal 1 (+) and Terminal 2 (-)  
EIA-485 (TERM) - TB7  
Terminal Mode annunciator connector, Terminal 5 (In +), 6 (In -), 7 (Out +), 8 (Out -)  
Supervised, power-limited.  
EIA-232 Serial - TB7  
Local serial PC/Printer Connector, Terminal 1 (Transmit), 2 (Receive), 3 (DTR), 4 (Ground)  
Non-supervised, power-limited.  
16  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Controls and Indicators  
Product Description  
1.3.1 Current Availability  
The following figure illustrates the maximum current that is possible for each panel circuit and the  
total current available from the FACP power supply.  
TB3  
Resettable Special  
Application Power  
1
1.5 amps max  
per circuit  
for 4-wire smoke detectors  
2
3
4
5
6
Standby  
1.5 Amps Max*  
per panel  
Resettable Special  
Application Power  
Power #1  
1.5 amps max  
per circuit  
Resettable Special  
Application Power  
Power #2  
1.5 amps max  
per circuit  
Alarm  
7 Amps Max  
per panel  
1
NAC 1  
Style Y or Z  
3 amps max  
per circuit  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
NAC 3  
Style Y only  
3 amps max  
per circuit  
NAC 2  
Style Y or Z  
3 amps max  
per circuit  
NAC 4  
Style Y only  
3 amps max  
per circuit  
TB4  
*The combined output current of all Special Applications Power circuits cannot exceed 1.5 amps in standby. Each  
circuit is capable of delivering the full 1.5 amps individually.  
Refer to the battery calculations section for additional information.  
Figure 1.1 Current Availability  
1.4 Controls and Indicators  
LCD Display  
HONEYWELL  
LIFE SAFETY  
SYSTEM ALL NORMAL  
10:00A 020102  
The FACP uses an 80-character (4 lines X 20  
characters) high viewing angle LCD display.  
The display includes a long life LED backlight  
that remains illuminated. If AC power is lost and  
the system is not in alarm, the LED backlight will  
turn off to conserve batteries.  
LED Indicators  
LED indicators are provided to annunciate the following conditions:  
AC Power (green)  
Fire Alarm (red)  
Supervisory (yellow)  
Trouble (yellow)  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Product Description  
Circuits  
Maintenance/presignal (yellow)  
Alarm Silenced signals (yellow)  
Disabled (yellow)  
Battery fault (yellow)  
Ground fault (yellow)  
Key Panel  
Mounted on the main circuit board, the key panel includes a window for the LCD display and LED  
indicators as listed above. The key panel, which is visible with the cabinet door closed, has 25  
keys, including a 16 key alpha-numeric pad similar to a telephone keypad.  
Function keys:  
Acknowledge/Step  
Alarm Silence  
Drill  
Reset (lamp test)  
Service/program keys:  
Keys labeled 1 to 9  
* key  
# key  
0 (recall) key  
1st Event key  
Figure 1.2 Membrane/Display Panel  
Clear key  
Escape key  
Mode key  
Four cursor keys (up, down, left and right)  
Enter key  
Local Piezo Sounder  
A piezo sounder provides separate and distinct pulse rates for alarm, trouble and supervisory condi-  
tions.  
1.5 Circuits  
SLC Communication Loop  
One SLC loop is provided standard on the FACP main circuit board. A second SLC loop is avail-  
able by plugging the optional SLC module into connector J3 on the main circuit board. SLC loops,  
configurable for NFPA Style 4, 6 or 7, provide communication to addressable detectors, monitor  
(initiating device) and control (output device) modules. Refer to the SLC Wiring Manual for infor-  
mation on wiring devices.  
Output Circuits  
The following output circuits are available on the FACP:  
Special Application Power  
• 24 VDC Resettable (smoke detector power) output - 1.5 amps maximum  
• 24 VDC Nonresettable power output #1 - 1.5 amps maximum  
• 24 VDC Nonresettable power output #2 - 1.5 amps maximum  
24 VDC Battery Charger (up to 26 AH batteries)  
18  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                   
Components  
Product Description  
NAC (Notification Appliance Circuits)  
Up to four NACs are provided with various programmable features:  
four Style Y (Class B) NACs  
OR  
two Style Z (Class A) NACs  
Relays  
One fixed and two fully programmable Form-C dry contact relays are provided. The fixed fail-safe  
relay monitors system trouble and the two programmable relays are factory default programmed for  
system alarm and system supervisory. Contacts are rated 2.0 amps @ 30 VDC (resistive) and 0.5  
amps @ 30 VAC (resistive). The programmable relays can be programmed for the following oper-  
ations:  
fire alarm  
trouble  
supervisory  
supervisory auto-resettable  
DACT communication failure  
process monitor  
process monitor auto-resettable  
hazard alert  
medical alert  
AC loss  
Auxiliary Trouble Inputs  
Auxiliary Trouble Inputs can be connected to trouble bus outputs from auxiliary equipment, such as  
power supplies or normally-open dry contacts of a trouble relay to allow monitoring by the FACP.  
1.6 Components  
Main Circuit Board  
The main circuit board contains the system’s CPU and other primary components and wiring inter-  
face connectors. Optional modules plug in and are mounted to the main circuit board. The circuit  
board is delivered mounted to a chassis which must be mounted to the backbox. Refer to the circuit  
board illustration on Page 10.  
FLPS-7 Power Supply  
The FLPS-7 Power Supply is provided as a separate module which is delivered mounted to a chas-  
sis which must be mounted to the backbox and connected to the main circuit board.  
Cabinet  
The FACP cabinet is red with a navy blue front overlay.  
The backbox provides space for two batteries (up to 18 Amp Hour).  
Ample knockouts are provided for system wiring. Also available is an  
optional dress panel DP-9692, which mounts to the inside of the cabinet  
(required by ULC for Canadian applications).  
Batteries  
Batteries must be sealed lead acid type. The FACP cabinet provides space for two batteries (up to  
18 Amp Hour). Batteries larger than 18 Amp Hour up to 26 Amp Hour require use of the BB-26 or  
similar UL listed battery cabinet. The CHG-75 can be used for charging 26 to 75 AH batteries and  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Product Description  
Components  
the BB-26 can be used for housing the batteries. The CHG-120F can be used for charging 26 to 120  
AH batteries and the BB-55F can be used for housing the batteries. Batteries must be ordered sep-  
arately.  
1.6.1 Intelligent Addressable Detectors: Newer Series  
Intelligent, addressable detectors provide information to the control panel on an SLC Signaling  
Line Circuit (refer to the SLC Wiring Manual for detailed information on device installation, wir-  
ing and operation). This allows the control panel to continually process the information to deter-  
mine the status (alarm, trouble, maintenance or normal) of each detector. Each detector responds to  
an SLC address that is set in the detector head using built-in rotary decimal switches with the abil-  
ity to select up to 159 addresses. Note that a blinking LED on an intelligent detector indicates com-  
munication between the detector and the control panel.  
These devices (350 Series or newer) can operate in CLIP mode (Classic Loop Interface Protocol) or  
LiteSpeed mode to provide a quicker response. They are also compatible with older 300 Series  
devices. If a mix of old and new series devices are installed on the same loop, that loop must be  
programmed to operate in CLIP mode. Refer to the SLC Wiring Manual for a complete list of com-  
patible addressable detectors.  
1.6.2 Intelligent Addressable Modules: Newer Series  
The newer series of Control Modules and Monitor Modules provide an interface between the con-  
trol panel and conventional notification and initiating devices. Each module can be set to respond  
to an address with built-in rotary switches with the ability to select up to 159 addresses (a tab on the  
address switch must be broken off to use addresses 100-159). A blinking LED on a monitor mod-  
ule indicates communication between the module and the control panel.  
These devices (350 Series or newer) can operate in CLIP mode (Classic Loop Interface Protocol) or  
LiteSpeed mode to provide a quicker response. They are also compatible with older 300 Series  
devices. If a mix of old and new series devices are installed on the same loop, the loop must be pro-  
grammed to operate in CLIP mode. Refer to the SLC Wiring Manual for a complete list of compat-  
ible addressable modules. Refer to the Device Compatibility Document for a list of approved  
notification and initiating devices.  
1.6.3 300 Series Intelligent Addressable Devices  
Fire•Lite’s 300 Series Intelligent Addressable Devices are fully compatible with the MS-9600LS  
FACP. The FACP must be configured for CLIP Mode operation if the control panel is installed in  
an existing system with 300 Series devices. The address of 300 Series devices cannot be set above  
99. Refer to the SLC Wiring Manual for a complete list of compatible addressable devices.  
1.6.4 Addressable Device Accessories  
End-of-Line Resistor Assembly P/N R-47K  
The 47 KEnd-of-Line Resistor assembly (P/N: R-47K) is used to supervise the MMF-300,  
MDF-300, MMF-301 and CMF-300 module circuits. The 3.9 KEnd-of-Line Resistor assembly  
is used to supervise the MMF-302 module circuit. The resistors are included with each module.  
Power Supervision Relay  
The UL listed End-of-Line power supervision relay (P/N: EOLR-1) is used to supervise the power  
to 4-wire smoke detectors and notification appliances.  
20  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
Optional Modules  
Product Description  
N-ELR Mounting Plate  
The N-ELR is a single End-of-Line resistor plate which is required for use in Canada. An ELR,  
which is supplied with each module and fire alarm control panel, is mounted to the ELR plate.  
Resistors mounted to the N-ELR plate can be used for the supervision of a monitor and control  
module circuit.  
1.7 Optional Modules  
The FACP main circuit board includes option module connectors for the following modules:  
4XTMF Transmitter Module  
The 4XTMF provides a supervised output for local energy municipal box transmitter, alarm and  
trouble reverse polarity. It includes a disable switch and disable trouble LED. A jumper on the  
module is used to select an option which allows the reverse polarity circuit to open with a system  
trouble condition if no alarm condition exists. The module plugs into connectors J10 and J11  
which are located near the top left of the main circuit board. When the 4XTMF module is installed,  
Jumper JP6, on the main circuit board, must be cut to allow supervision of the module.  
SLC-2LS Expander Module  
The SLC-2LS Expander Module allows expansion of the FACP from one SLC circuit to two SLC  
circuits. The module plugs into connector J3 which is located in the lower right corner of the main  
circuit board. The wiring for the second SLC connects to terminals located on the expander mod-  
ule.  
DACT-UD2 Digital Alarm Communicator/Transmitter  
The DACT-UD2 is used to transmit system status to UL-listed Central Station receivers via the  
public switched telephone network. All circuitry and connectors are contained on a compact mod-  
ule which plugs into connector J2, which is located near the bottom center of the main circuit  
board.  
The MS-9600UDLS/E is provided with a factory installed DACT-UD2. Refer to “DACT-UD2  
Installation” on page 52 and to the DACT-UD2 manual, which is included with the FACP, for  
DACT-UD2 wiring and programming information.  
IPDACT - Internet Protocol DACT  
The IPDACT is a compact, Internet Protocol Digital Alarm Communicator/Transmitter designed to  
allow FACP status communication to a Central Station via the internet. No telephone lines are  
required when using the IPDACT. Using Contact ID protocol from the FACP, the IPDACT con-  
verts the standard DACT phone communication to a protocol that can be transmitted and received  
via the internet. It also checks connectivity between the FACP and Central Station. Refer to the  
IPDACT Product Installation Document P/N 53109 for additional information.  
1.8 Accessories  
1.8.1 PS-Tools Programming Utility  
The PS-Tools Programming Utility can be used to locally or remotely program the FACP directly  
from most IBM compatible computers (PC), running Windows™ XP or newer. FACP program  
files can also be created and stored on the PC and then downloaded later to the control panel. The  
P/N: PK-CD Kit includes the FACP Windows-based Programming Utility software on CD-ROM  
with on-line help file. A standard USB cable with male-A to male-B connectors, which must be  
purchased separately, is required by the MS-9600UDLS for local connection of the PC to the USB  
port J4 on the DACT-UD2. The MS-9600LS requires connection to the Serial Port on FACP con-  
nector TB7. Remote programming requires that the PC have a 2400 baud or faster modem.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Product Description  
Accessories  
Important: Remote modification of FACP programming requires that the panel be enabled for  
remote download (refer to the DACT-UD2 manual). Remote interrogation of panel programming,  
history logs, detector status, etc., is possible without enabling the remote download option.  
1.8.2 Dress Panel: DP-9692  
A DP-9692 dress panel is available for the FACP (required for Canadian installations). The dress  
panel restricts access to the system wiring while allowing access to the key panel.  
The MS-9600LSC has received ULC approval. ULC approval is contingent on the proper installa-  
tion of the dress panel which is provided with the FACP  
1.8.3 TR-CE Trim Ring  
An optional TR-CE trim ring is available for semi-flush mounting the FACP backbox.  
1.8.4 Battery Box  
BB-26  
The BB-26 battery box may be used to house up to two 26 AH batteries and the CHG-75 Battery  
Charger. The battery box is red and is provided with knockouts.  
BB-55F  
The BB-55F battery box may be used to house two 26 AH batteries, two 60 AH batteries or one  
100 AH battery. When the CHG-120 is mounted in the BB-55F, two 26 AH or one 60 AH battery  
may also be housed in the battery box.  
1.8.5 Battery Charger  
CHG-75 Battery Charger  
The CHG-75 is capable of charging up to 75 AH lead-acid batteries with the MS-9600LS FACP.  
The FACP battery charger must be disabled when using the CHG-75. The charger and up to 26 AH  
batteries can be housed in the BB-26 battery box. Larger batteries and the charger can be housed in  
the BB-55F battery box which can be mounted up to 20 feet away from the control panel. Refer to  
the CHG-75 Manual for additional information.  
CHG-120 Battery Charger  
The CHG-120 is capable of charging up to 120 AH lead-acid batteries with the FACP. The FACP  
battery charger must be disabled when using the CHG-120. The batteries and charger can be  
housed in the BB-55F battery box which can be mounted up to 20 feet away from the control panel.  
Note that when using the BB-55F for housing the charger and batteries greater than 26AH, multiple  
BB-55Fs are required. Refer to the CHG-120 Manual for additional information.  
22  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Accessories  
Product Description  
1.8.6 New ANN-BUS Annunciators/Devices  
NOTE: Refer to “Canadian Application” on page 200 for specific Canadian requirements.  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
DISCONNECT ALL SOURCES OF POWER (AC AND DC) BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING  
ANY MODULES OR WIRING.  
!
The legacy ACS annunciators may not be used if new ANN-BUS annunciators are being used due  
to incompatible serial communication protocols.  
A variety of optional devices can be connected to the FACP EIA-485 ANN-BUS communication  
circuit. Compatible devices include:  
ANN-80 LCD Annunciator  
ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel Printer Interface Module  
ANN-I/O LED Driver Module  
ANN-LED Annunciator Module (alarm, trouble, supervisory LEDs)  
ANN-RLED Annunciator Module (red alarm LEDs only)  
ANN-RLY Relay Module  
ANN-BUS Wiring  
This section contains information on calculating ANN-BUS wire distances and the types of wiring  
configurations (Class B).  
Calculating Wiring Distance for ANN-BUS Modules  
The following instructions will guide the installer in determining the type of wire and the maximum  
wiring distance that can be used with FACP ANN-BUS accessory modules.  
To calculate the wire gauge that must be used to connect ANN-BUS modules to the FACP, it is nec-  
essary to calculate the total worst case current draw for all modules on a single 4-conductor bus.  
The total worst case current draw is calculated by adding the individual worst case currents for each  
module. The individual worst case values are shown in the following table:  
Worst Case Current Draw1  
Model Number  
ANN-80 LCD Annunciator  
0.040 amps  
0.040 amps  
0.200 amps  
0.068 amps  
0.075 amps  
ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel Printer Interface Module  
ANN-I/O LED Driver Module  
ANN-(R)LED Annunciator Module  
ANN-RLY Relay Module  
1 Total worst case current draw on a single ANN-BUS cannot exceed 0.5 amp. If  
current draw exceeds 0.5 amps, refer to “Powering ANN-BUS Devices from  
Auxiliary Power Supply” on page 26.  
After calculating the total worst case current draw, Table 1.1 specifies the maximum distance the  
modules can be located from the FACP on a single wire run. The table ensures 6.0 volts of line  
drop maximum. In general, the wire length is limited by resistance, but for heavier wire gauges,  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Product Description  
Accessories  
capacitance is the limiting factor. These cases are marked in the chart with an asterisk (*). Maxi-  
mum length can never be more than 6,000 feet (1,800 m), regardless of gauge used. The formula  
used to generate this chart is shown in the note below.  
Wiring Distance: ANN-BUS Modules to FACP  
Total Worst Case Current  
22 Gauge  
18 Gauge  
16 Gauge  
14 Gauge  
Draw (amps)  
0.100  
1,852 ft.  
926 ft.  
617 ft.  
463 ft.  
370 ft.  
4,688 ft.  
2,344 ft.  
1,563 ft.  
1,172 ft.  
938 ft.  
* 6,000 ft.  
3,731 ft.  
2,488 ft.  
1,866 ft.  
1,493 ft.  
*6,000 ft.  
5,906 ft.  
3,937 ft.  
2,953 ft.  
2,362 ft.  
0.200  
0.300  
0.400  
0.500  
Table 1.1 Wiring Distances  
The following formulas were used to generate the wire distance chart:  
6.0 volts  
Maximum Resistance (Ohms)  
=
=
Total Worst Case Current Draw (amps)  
Maximum Wire Length (feet)  
(6,000 feet maximum)  
Maximum Resistance (Ohms)  
Rpu  
*500  
where: Rpu = Ohms per 1,000 feet for various Wire Gauges (see table below)  
Wire Gauge  
Ohms per 1,000 feet (Rpu)  
22  
18  
16  
14  
16.2  
6.4  
4.02  
2.54  
Exception: When using the ANN-RLY module, the installer must ensure that the maximum  
24VDC power line drop does not exceed 0.3 volts. This results in the following wiring limitations:  
Wire Gauge  
Maximum Wire Length  
312 feet  
18  
16  
14  
12  
497 feet  
787 feet  
1,250 feet  
Wiring Distance Calculation Example:  
Suppose a system is configured with the following ANN-BUS modules:  
3 ANN-80 Remote Fire Annunciators  
1 ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel Printer Interface Module  
1 ANN-I/O LED Driver Module  
24  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
Product Description  
The total worst case current is calculated as follows:  
ANN-80 Current Draw  
= 3 X 0.040 amps  
= 1 X.0.040 amps  
= 1 X.0.200 amps  
= 0.120 amps  
= 0.040 amps  
= 0.200 amps  
= 0.360 amp  
ANN-S/PG Current Draw  
ANN-I/O Current Draw  
Total Worst Case Current Draw  
Using this value and referring to the Wiring Distance Table 1.1 on page 24, it can be found that the  
available options are:  
463 feet maximum using 22 Gauge wire  
1,172 feet maximum using 18 Gauge wire  
1,866 feet maximum using 16 Gauge wire  
2,953 feet maximum using 14 Gauge wire  
Wiring Configuration  
Figure 1.3 illustrates the wiring between the FACP and ANN-BUS devices.  
ANN-BUS and power wiring are  
supervised and power-limited  
B
4
A
(+) (-)  
TB1  
3
2
1
ANN-BUS/  
ACS BUS  
ANN-BUS Device  
24 VDC  
nonresettable  
TB1  
TB5  
A B  
TB6 + -  
TB3 + - + - + -  
TB4  
JP8  
JP5  
FACP  
Figure 1.3 FACP wiring to ANN-BUS Device  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
Powering ANN-BUS Devices from Auxiliary Power Supply  
Accessories  
Figure 1.4 illustrates the powering of ANN-BUS devices from an auxiliary power supply such as  
the FCPS-24FS6/8, when the total ANN-BUS power requirement exceeds the capability of the  
FACP’s DC Power Output circuit.  
Cut Ground Fault Detection jumper JP1 (FACP monitors for ground faults)  
ANN-BUS and power wiring are  
supervised and power-limited  
-24 VDC  
ANN-80  
ANN-BUS  
+24 VDC  
nonresettable  
ANN-BUS/  
ACS BUS  
FCPS-24FS6/8  
FACP  
Figure 1.4 Powering ANN-BUS Devices from FCPS-24FS6/8  
ANN-BUS Device Addressing  
Each ANN-BUS device requires a unique address (ID Number) in order to communicate with the  
FACP. A 5-position DIP switch on each device is used to set this address. The address set for these  
devices must also be programmed at the FACP for the specific device (refer to the programming  
A maximum of 8 devices can be connected to the FACP ANN-BUS communication circuit. Device  
addresses do not need to be sequential and can be set to any number between 01 and 08. Note that  
00 is not a valid address. The following table shows the DIP switch setting for each address.  
NOTE: Address (ID Number) DIP switches on some devices may have more than 5 switch  
positions. Unless otherwise specified in the documentation supplied with each device, switch  
positions 6 and above must be set to OFF.  
26  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Product Description  
Switch 51  
OFF  
Address  
Switch 4  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Switch 3  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Switch 2  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Switch 1  
not valid  
01  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
02  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
03  
OFF  
ON  
04  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
05  
OFF  
ON  
06  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
07  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
08  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
1 Switch 5 must be set to OFF for ANN-BUS devices to be recognized.  
ANN-80 Remote Fire Annunciator  
The ANN-80(-W) Annunciator is a compact, 80 character, backlit LCD remote fire annunciator. It  
mimics the display on the control panel and will annunciate device type, point alarm, trouble or  
supervisory condition, zone assignment plus any custom alpha labels programmed into the FACP.  
The annunciator also provides system status LEDs to display AC Power, Alarm, Trouble, Supervi-  
sory and Alarm Silenced conditions. Additionally, the annunciator is capable of remotely perform-  
ing critical system functions such as Acknowledge, Silence, Reset and Drill. Communication  
between the ANN-80 and FACP is accomplished over a two wire RS-485 serial interface employ-  
ing the ANN-BUS communication format. The devices are powered, via two additional wires,  
from either the host FACP or remote UL-listed, filtered, power supply.  
The function buttons, keyswitch and piezo sounder may be individually enabled and disabled  
through the FACP software. Refer to “ANN-BUS Options” on page 121 for a description of this  
feature and programming information.  
Note that if the keyswitch is enabled and remains in the unlocked position for more than two min-  
utes without any buttons being pressed on the annunciator, a trouble indication will be annunciated.  
Specifications  
Operating Voltage Range: 18 VDC to 28 VDC  
Current Consumption @ 24 VDC nominal (filtered and nonresettable):  
• Normal/Standby (no activity): 37.0 mA  
• Trouble: 39.0 mA  
• Alarm: 40.0 mA  
• AC Fail ( not backlit): 15.0 mA  
For use indoors in a dry location  
Installation  
Ensure that all power (AC and DC) has been removed from the FACP before installing the annunci-  
ator.  
Opening/Closing Annunciator  
The following procedure details the steps used to open the annunciator in order to access the termi-  
nal block and DIP switches (refer to Figure 1.5 on page 28):  
1. Turn the key switch to the ON (Unlocked) position by turning the key counter-clockwise.  
2. Push in the snap latch located on the right side of the unit while pulling the cover open.  
3. To close the cover, make certain the key switch is in the ON (Unlocked) position. Swing the  
cover closed, snapping it shut.  
4. Turn the key switch to the OFF (Locked) position by turning clockwise and remove the key.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Product Description  
Accessories  
Annunciator backplate  
Annunciator cover  
with LCD display  
Press in latch  
and  
Pull annunciator  
cover open  
Key switch shown in OFF/Locked position  
Figure 1.5 ANN-80  
Mounting  
TheANN-80 can be surface or semi-flush mounted to a single, double or 4” square electrical box.  
Select and remove the appropriate knockout(s), pull the necessary wires through the knockouts and  
mount the annunciator in or on the wall depending on the type of installation desired.  
The ANN-SB80KIT(-R/-B/-W) is an available mounting kit for the ANN-80 annunciator. The kit  
comes with a surface backbox and surface wedge for angled viewing. The two pieces can be used  
separately or can be stacked together.  
The ANN-80 cover must be attached to the annunciator backplate before mounting the annunciator  
to the electrical box/wall. The cover cannot be reattached or removed after the annunciator has  
been mounted.  
Annunciator mounted on  
surface wedge from the  
ANN-SB80KIT  
Annunciator mounted on  
surface backbox from the  
ANN-SB80KIT  
Annunciator mounted on stacked  
surface wedge and backbox from  
the ANN-SB80KIT  
28  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
Product Description  
Wiring ANN-80 to FACP  
The following steps can be used as a guide to wire the annunciator. Make certain all power has  
been removed from the FACP prior to annunciator installation.  
1. Route wires from hole in backplate, through wiring channel and then to ANN-80 terminal  
block TB1.  
wiring channel  
wires  
TB1  
2. Remove appropriate amount of wire insulation.  
3. Connect the wiring from the FACP ANN-BUS to annunciator TB1 terminals 3 (A) & 4 (B).  
Make certain to connect A to A and B to B.  
4. If appropriate, connect the wiring going to the next device on the ANN-BUS to TB1 terminals  
3 & 4. Make certain to connect A to A and B to B.  
5. Connect the wiring from the 24 VDC power source to annunciator TB1 terminals 1 (-) & 2 (+).  
Make certain to observe proper polarity.  
6. If appropriate, connect the power wiring going to the next device to terminals  
1 (-) & 2 (+). Make certain to observe proper polarity.  
7. After all connections are made, remove extra wire from inside of annunciator by dressing it  
neatly through wire channel, with any excess wire pushed back through hole into electrical  
box.  
ANN-BUS and power wiring are  
supervised and power-limited  
ANN-BUS  
B
4
A
(+) (-)  
TB1  
24 VDC  
nonresettable  
3
2
1
ANN-BUS/  
ACS BUS  
ANN-80  
TB1  
TB5  
A B  
TB6 + -  
TB3 + - + - + -  
TB4  
JP8  
JP5  
FACP  
Figure 1.6 ANN-80 Wiring to FACP  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
The following table shows the ANN-80 connections to the FACP  
Accessories  
FACP  
ANN-80 (TB1)  
Terminal GND (-) on TB3  
Terminal PWR (+)TB3  
Terminal ACS on TB6  
Terminal ACS on TB6  
Terminal 1 (-)  
Terminal 2 (+)  
Terminal 3 (A)  
Terminal 4 (B)  
Programming  
Following installation and wiring of the ANN-80 LCD annunciator to the FACP, the annunciator  
must added to the system via FACP programming. Refer to the programming section titled “ANN-  
BUS Options” on page 121 in this manual for detailed programming information. Select the LCD  
option for programming.  
Trouble Response  
If the ANN-80 is installed but the ANN-BUS is not enabled at the FACP, the ANN-80 will indicate  
a trouble condition by NOT turning on its AC Power indicator. The LCD will also display Key Bus  
Trouble and the piezo will sound approximately once every 10 seconds. Note that the FACP will  
provide no indication of an ANN-80 trouble.  
To clear the ANN-80 trouble condition, enable the ANN-BUS and program the address correspond-  
ing to the address set on the ANN-80 at the FACP.  
If the Keyswitch on the ANN-80 is left in the unlocked position for more than 2 minutes, a trouble  
condition will be indicated at the FACP.  
ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel Interface Installation  
The ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel Interface module allows the connection of a remote serial or parallel  
printer to the FACP for a real-time log of system events, detector status reports and event history.  
The module is provided with a plastic enclosure for surface mounting. Proceed with the installation  
as described in the following:  
1. Ensure that all power (AC and DC) has been removed from the FACP.  
2. Connect the ANN-S/PG to the FACP as illustrated in Figure 1.7.  
Parallel  
ANN-BUS and power wiring are  
supervised and power-limited  
(-)  
Cable Connectors for  
connection to printer  
(+)  
A
B
Serial  
ANN-S/PG Module  
ANN-BUS/  
24 VDC  
ACS BUS  
nonresettable  
TB1  
TB5  
+ - + - + -  
+ -  
A B  
TB3  
TB4  
JP8  
TB6  
FACP  
JP5  
Figure 1.7 ANN-S/PG Connection to FACP  
3. Using the DIP switches on the back of the ANN-S/PG module, assign an ID number (address)  
to the module.  
30  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
Product Description  
4. Select the address and configuration options for the ANN-S/PG module as described in the  
Programming section of this manual (refer to “ANN-BUS Options” on page 121).  
Note that the Auto-configure feature allows the programmer to quickly bring all installed  
5. Connect a printer to the ANN-S/PG Parallel or Serial connectors (refer to Figure 1.7). Only  
one printer can be connected.  
Specifications  
Operating Voltage: 24 VDC  
Current (Alarm and Standby): 45 mA  
Ambient Temperature: 32oF to 120oF (0oC to 49oC)  
Max. Wiring Distance from FACP: 6,000 ft. (1,800 m)  
Mounting: Surface  
Dimensions: 6”W x 7-3/4”H x 1-7/16”D (15.2 cm W x 19.7 cm H x 3.7 cm D)  
For indoor use in a dry location only  
PRN 6F Printer Installation  
When connected to the FACP via the ANN-S/PG module, the PRN-6F prints the status changes  
within the control panel and time-stamps the printout with the time of day and date that the event  
occurred. It provides 80 columns of data on standard 9” x 11” tractor-feed paper. This section con-  
tains information on connecting a printer to the control panel and setting the printer options.  
Connecting PRN-6F Printer  
Remote printers require a primary AC power source. If required for the fire alarm system configu-  
ration (for example, a Proprietary Fire Alarm System), a remote printer requires a secondary power  
source (battery backup). Since a secondary power source is not provided as a standard feature, a  
separate UL-listed Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) should be used. The building emergency  
power supply may be used, as long as it meets the power continuity requirements of NFPA 72.  
Refer to NFPA 72 for further details.  
Connect the remote printer to the FACP via the ANN-S/PG module using a standard DB-25 cable.  
One end of the cable will plug into the DB-25 connector on the PRN printer and the other end plugs  
into the parallel connector on the ANN-S/PG module. Note that the 9-pin DB-9 port on the ANN-  
S/PG is used to connect a serial printer. The 25-pin port is used for a Centronics parallel printer  
cable. Connect either a serial or parallel printer, but not both at the same time.  
Setting Printer Options  
Refer to the documentation supplied with the PRN-6F printer for instructions on using the printer  
menu controls. Set the printer options (under the menu area) as shown in the following table:  
Option  
Setting  
HS Draft  
Option  
Setting  
Font  
LPI  
CPI  
10CPI  
0.5  
6 LPI  
Skip  
ESC Character  
Bidirectional Copy  
CG-TAB  
ESC  
Emulate  
I/O  
Epson FX-850  
ON  
Graphic  
E-US ASCII  
OFF  
Buffer  
Serial  
Baud  
40K  
Country  
Auto CR  
9600 or 2400  
7 Bit, Even, 1 Stop  
XON/XOFF  
Color Option  
Formien  
Not Installed  
Format  
Protocol  
Lines  
6LPI=60  
Character Set  
Standard  
Table 1.2 PRN-6F Setup Options  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
Accessories  
Standard  
Exec 10.5  
SI.Zero  
Auto LF  
PAPER  
BIN 1  
On  
On  
12/72”  
12/72”  
12/72”  
12/72”  
12/72”  
12/72”  
BIN 2  
SINGLE  
PUSH TRA  
PULL TRA  
PAP ROLL  
Table 1.2 PRN-6F Setup Options  
ANN-I/O LED Driver Module*  
The ANN-I/O is an LED driver module that can be used in a wide variety of applications, including  
as an interface with most customized graphic annunciators. The ANN-I/O can drive up to 40 LEDs  
The module is provided with a plastic enclosure for mounting inside the annunciator or accessory  
box. The following sections describe hardware installation. Refer to the section titled “ANN-BUS  
Options” on page 121 for programming information.  
*In Canada, the color red must be used to indicate active alarm inputs. Yellow indicates supervi-  
sory, burglary or trouble signals. Green indicates the presence of power or an activated output.  
ANN-I/O Board Layout  
Figure 1.8 illustrates the ANN-I/O board showing locations of screw terminals for connection to  
the FACP, pin connectors for connecting LEDs and the DIP switch for selecting the ANN-BUS ID  
number.  
Terminals not used (future)  
ANN-BUS (ID#)  
Address DIP  
switch  
ANN-BUS Connector  
Figure 1.8 ANN-I/O Board Layout  
32  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Product Description  
Specifications  
Max. ANN-BUS Voltage: 28 VDC  
Max. Current:  
• Alarm: 200 mA  
• Standby: 35 mA  
• Each LED: 10 mA  
Operating Temperature: 32oF to 120oF (0oC to 49oC)  
For indoor use in a dry location only  
ANN-I/O Connection to FACP  
The ANN-I/O connects to the FACP via the ANN-BUS as illustrated in Figure 1.9. After the  
ANN-I/O is connected to the panel, it must be added to the system via FACP programming. Refer  
P1  
P2  
P3  
P4  
21  
30  
11  
31  
40  
1
10  
20  
ANN-I/O Module  
24 VDC  
nonresettable  
ANN-BUS/  
ACS BUS  
ANN-BUS and power wiring are  
supervised and power-limited  
TB1  
+ -  
TB3 + - + - + -  
A B  
TB5  
TB4  
JP8  
TB6  
JP5  
FACP  
Figure 1.9 ANN-I/O Connection to FACP  
ANN-I/O Module LED Wiring  
There are four 12-pin connectors on the ANN-I/O module for connecting LEDs. Each set of 10  
LEDs get their power from Pin 11 of the corresponding connector. Internal resistors are sized so  
that there is approximately 10 mA of current for each LED. No series resistors are required. Refer  
to the programming section titled “ANN-I/O Options” on page 123 of this manual.  
The LEDs are wired as illustrated in Figure 1.10. Note that the illustration depicts only connectors  
P1 and P2. Wiring is identical for P3 (LEDs 21-30) and P4 (LEDs 31-40).  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
Accessories  
Figure 1.10 ANN-I/O Board Layout  
ANN-LED Annunciator Module*  
The ANN-LED and ANN-RLED annunciator modules provide LED annunciation of general sys-  
tem faults and input zones/points when used with a compatible FACP. The ANN-LED module pro-  
vides alarm (red), trouble (yellow) and supervisory (yellow) indication for up to ten input zones or  
addressable points. The ANN-LEDR provides alarm (red) indication for up to 30 input zones or  
addressable points. Multiple ANN-(R)LED modules may be used for full system coverage.  
34  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Product Description  
*In Canada, the color red must be used to indicate active alarm inputs. Yellow indicates supervi-  
sory, burglary or trouble signals. Green indicates the presence of power or an activated output.  
Figure 1.11 ANN-LEDs (shown in possible stacked configuration)  
Specifications  
Max. ANN-BUS Voltage: 24 VDC  
Max. Current:  
• Alarm: 68 mA  
• Standby: 28 mA  
o
o
o
o
Operating Temperature: 32 F to 120 F (0 C to 49 C)  
For indoor use in a dry location only  
Mounting/Installation  
Refer to the documentation supplied with the ANN-LED module for mounting information.  
Figure 1.12 Exploded View of ANN-LED  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
ANN-LED Board Layout and Connection to FACP  
Accessories  
Figure 1.13 illustrates the ANN-LED board showing locations of screw terminals for connection to  
the FACP and the DIP switches for selecting the ANN-BUS ID number.  
ANN-BUS (ID#)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Address DIP switch  
ANN-BUS  
TB1  
ANN-BUS and power wiring are  
supervised and power-limited  
ANN-LED  
ANN-BUS/  
ACS BUS  
+24 VDC  
-24 VDC  
TB1  
TB5  
TB3 + - + - + -  
+ -  
A B  
TB4  
JP8  
TB6  
JP5  
FACP  
Figure 1.13 ANN-LED Connection to FACP  
ANN-RLY Annunciator Module  
The ANN-RLY relay module provides 10 programmable Form-C relays when used with a  
compatible FACP.  
Specifications  
Operating Voltage: 24 VDC  
Max. Current:  
Alarm: 75 mA  
Standby: 15 mA  
Relay Contact Ratings  
2 amps @ 30 VDC (resistive)  
0.5 amps @ 30 VAC (resistive)  
o
o
o
o
Operating Temperature: 32 F to 120 F (0 C to 49 C)  
For indoor use in a dry location only  
36  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Accessories  
Product Description  
Mounting/Installation  
The ANN-RLY relay module can be mounted inside the FACP main circuit board chassis or inside  
the ROME Series enclosure. Refer to the ANN-RLY Installation Document #53033 for instructions  
on chassis mounting or to the ROME Series Installation Document #53530 for mounting in the sep-  
arate backbox.  
FACP Chassis Installation  
mounting holes  
mounting hooks through  
mounting slots  
FACP Backbox Installation  
using ANN-MBRLY mounting bracket  
grounding wire  
mounting holes  
ANN-MBRLY  
mounting bracket  
ANN-RLY  
mounting holes  
mounting holes  
ROME Series Installation  
using ANN-MBRLY mounting bracket  
ANN-RLY on ANN-  
MBRLY mounting  
bracket  
mounting holes  
Figure 1.14 ANN-RLY Mounting Options  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
Accessories  
ANN-RLY Board Layout and Connection to FACP  
Figure 1.15 illustrates the ANN-RLY board showing locations of screw terminals for connection to  
the FACP and the DIP switches for selecting the ANN-BUS ID number.  
ANN-BUS (ID#)  
Address DIP switch  
Ground Wire  
ANN-RLY  
attaches to chassis  
(see documentation  
supplied with module)  
ANN-BUS  
+24 VDC  
-24 VDC  
FACP  
Figure 1.15 ANN-RLY Board Layout and Connection to FACP  
ANN-BUS Audio Panel Control  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
DISCONNECT ALL SOURCES OF POWER (AC AND DC) BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING  
ANY MODULES OR WIRING.  
!
The FACP is capable of providing automated activation of the ACC-25/50(ZS/T) zoned system  
speaker circuits. To do this, the FACP must be enabled to communicate with the ACC-25/50ZS  
Audio Panel over the ANN-BUS (refer to “ANN-BUS Enabled” on page 121). This is accom-  
plished by programming the Audio Panel ANN-BUS address into the FACP (refer to “Modules  
Installed” on page 121). For details on setting the ANN-BUS address and programming the audio  
panel, refer to the ACC-25/50ZS Series Audio Panel manual (document #51889).  
The ACC-25/50ZS Series audio panel connects to the FACP via the ACS/ANN-BUS communica-  
tion circuit. Zones 33 - 56 on the FACP correspond to the ACC-25/50ZS Series audio circuits  
1 - 24. Zone 32 on the FACP serves as the All-Call zone and will activate all audio panel output  
circuits. The programmer can select which of the five audio messages at the audio panel will play  
when an FACP input zone goes into alarm (refer to “Zone Message” on page 149). The message  
will play over the corresponding audio panel output circuit.  
38  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessories  
Product Description  
Examples:  
FACP Input programmed to Zone 33 goes into alarm, the programmed message for Zone 33  
[Message 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5] will play over the ACC-25/50ZS Series output circuit 1 which  
corresponds to FACP Zone 33.  
FACP Input programmed to Zone 1 and Zone 34 (Zone 1 is programmed for a Message [1, 2,  
3, 4 or 5] and Zone 34 is programmed for No Message) goes into alarm, the programmed  
message for Zone 1 will play over the ACC-25/50ZS Series output circuit 2 which corresponds  
to FACP Zone 34.  
If two or more input zones are active at the same time, the highest priority message will turn on  
(Message 1 is highest priority and Message 5 is lowest) and play over the corresponding audio  
panel output circuit(s).  
Zone 32 is an All-Call zone. All audio panel output circuits will turn on if Zone 32 is activated  
and its programmed message will play (or the highest priority message currently being  
played).  
A fault at the ACC-25/50ZS Series panel will cause the FACP to indicate a System Trouble and the  
display will indicate a Voice Evac Fault.  
The only connection between the FACP and ACC-25/50ZS Series audio panel is a pair of commu-  
nication wires connected between the A(+)/B(-) terminals on TB9 of the FACP and TB1 terminals  
2 & 3 of the ACC-ZPMK module on the audio panel.  
ACC-ZPMK  
on ACC-25/50ZS Series  
A (+)  
B (-)  
ANN-BUS  
FACP  
Figure 1.16 FACP Connection to ACC-25/50ZS Series Audio Panel  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Product Description  
Getting Started  
1.8.7 Legacy ACS Annunciators  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
DISCONNECT ALL SOURCES OF POWER (AC AND DC) BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING  
ANY MODULES OR WIRING.  
!
The legacy ACS annunciators may not be used if new ANN-BUS annunciators are being used due  
to incompatible serial communication protocols.  
ACM Series LED Zone Type Annunciators  
The ACM Series Annunciators remotely display alarm and trouble status as well as system status.  
For more detailed information, refer to the appropriate annunciator manual. Following is a list of  
annunciators which can be used with the FACP.  
ACM-16ATF - Annunciator Control Module annunciates 16 zones with 16 red alarm LEDs  
and 16 yellow trouble LEDs. In addition, it has a System Trouble LED, an On Line/Power  
LED and a local piezo sounder. *In Canada, this module must be used to annunciate the fire  
alarm input points/zones only.  
AEM-16ATF - Annunciator Expander Module annunciates 16 zones with 16 red alarm LEDs  
and 16 yellow trouble LEDs. *In Canada, this module must be used to annunciate the fire  
alarm input points/zones only.  
ACM-32A - Annunciator Control Module annunciates 32 alarm zones with 32 red LEDs. In  
addition, it has a System Trouble LED, an On Line/Power LED and a local piezo sounder. It  
also has a switch for local piezo silence. *In Canada, this module must be used to annunciate  
the fire alarm input points/zones only.  
AEM-32AF - Annunciator Expander Module annunciates 32 alarm zones with 32 red LEDs.  
*In Canada, this module must be used to annunciate the fire alarm input points/zones only.  
LCD-80F Remote Fire Annunciator  
The LCD-80F annunciator is an 80-character backlit LCD remote fire annunciator that is capable of  
displaying English language text. Tactile switches provide remote system Acknowledge, Silence,  
Drill and Reset functions. A keyswitch allows enabling/disabling of the tactile switches. Commu-  
nications between the control panel and the annunciator is accomplished over a serial interface  
employing the EIA-485 communication standard. Up to 32 LCD-80F annunciators may be con-  
nected to the EIA-485 circuit. The annunciators may be powered from the host FACP or a remote  
UL listed filtered power supply such as the FCPS Series. For more detailed information, refer to  
the LCD-80F manual.  
The LCD-80F is not for use in Canadian applications.  
LCD-80FC Remote Fire Annunciator (for use in Canadian applications)  
The LCD-80FC is identical to the LCD-80F except for the tactile switches and keyswitch. There is  
no keyswitch, and tactile switches are provided for local silence and lamp test only. No remote sys-  
tem functions can be performed from the LCD-80FC annunciator.  
LDM Series Lamp Driver Modules (Graphic Annunciator)  
The LDM Series Lamp Driver Modules, which consist of the LDM-32F master and LDM-E32F  
expander modules, are used to provide an interface to a custom graphic LED annunciator.  
1.9 Getting Started  
The following is a brief summary of the minimal steps involved in bringing an MS-9600LS/MS-  
9600UDLS on-line:  
Install Backbox, Power Supply and Main Circuit Board (refer to “Mounting” on page 42).  
Address and Install Intelligent Devices (refer to the SLC Wiring Manual).  
40  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Getting Started  
Product Description  
Enter Autoprogramming (refer to “Autoprogram” on page 66).  
Resolve Programming Conflicts.  
Go to Point Program to Enter Specific Data (refer to “Point Program” on page 67). Use the  
right and left arrow keys to navigate between devices.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2: Installation  
The cabinet may be either semi-flush or surface mounted. The cabinet mounts using key slots and  
two 0.250” (6.35 mm) diameter holes located in the backbox. The key slots are located at the top of  
the backbox and the two securing holes at the bottom.  
Carefully unpack the system and check for shipping damage. Mount the cabinet in a clean, dry,  
vibration-free area where extreme temperatures are not encountered. The area should be readily  
accessible with sufficient room to easily install and maintain the panel. Locate the top of the cabi-  
net approximately 5 feet (1.5 m) above the floor with the hinge mounting on the left. Determine the  
number of conductors required for the devices to be installed. Sufficient knockouts are provided  
for wiring convenience. Select the appropriate knockout(s) and pull the conductors into the box.  
All wiring should be in accordance with the National and/or Local codes for fire alarm systems.  
2.1 Mounting  
The circuit board contains static-sensitive components. Always ground yourself with a proper  
wrist strap before handling any boards so that static charges are removed from the body. Use static  
suppressive packaging to protect electronic assemblies.  
Mark and predrill holes in the wall for the center top keyhole mounting bolt using the dimen-  
sions illustrated in Figure 2.2 on page 44.  
Install center top fastener in the wall with the screw head protruding.  
Place backbox over the top screw, level, and secure.  
Mark and drill the left and right upper and lower mounting holes.  
Note: outer holes (closest to sidewall) are used for 16” O.C. stud mounting.  
Install remaining fasteners and tighten.  
Attach solid earth ground wire to grounding stud as indicated in Figure 2.1.  
When the location is dry and free of construction dust, install the main circuit board chassis by  
positioning the two mounting tab holes on the top of the chassis over the mounting studs in the  
top of the backbox and sliding the mounting tabs at the bottom of the chassis into the mounting  
slots in the bottom of the backbox as illustrated below.  
Secure the chassis to the mounting studs with the supplied nuts.  
42  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Mounting  
Installation  
Main Circuit Board on Chassis  
mounting tab holes  
mounting studs  
mounting tabs  
grounding stud:  
attach solid earth  
ground wire (refer to  
“AC Power and  
mounting slots  
Connection” on  
FACP Backbox  
Figure 2.1 FACP Main Circuit Board Installation  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installation  
Mounting  
3.37 cm  
1.325“  
3.37 cm  
1.325“  
5.1 cm  
2.00“  
2.00“  
2.00“  
2.00“  
2.00“  
2.00“  
2.00“  
1.625“ (4.128 cm)  
Semi-Flush Mounting  
Do not recess box  
more than 3.875” into  
wall to avoid covering  
venting holes on top of  
box.  
Hinge Slot for  
optional Dress Panel  
4.13 cm  
16.65“ (42.29 cm)  
12.00“ (30.48 cm)  
4.1 cm  
1.625“  
2.325“ (5.91 cm)  
1.625“  
4.13 cm  
1.625“  
4.1cm  
1.625“  
1.25“ (3.2 cm)  
7.0 cm  
2.75“  
12.13cm  
4.775"  
12.13 cm  
4.775“  
6.0“  
15.24 cm  
16.0“  
40.64 cm  
29.95 cm  
11.792“  
15.0“  
38.1 cm  
48.37cm  
19.0“  
17.83cm  
7.02“  
38.1 cm  
15.00“  
4.45cm  
1.75“  
Mounting  
slots for  
optional  
Trim Ring  
4.45cm  
1.75“  
Semi-flush  
mounting  
hole  
16.00“ (40.64 cm)  
2.00“  
4.128 cm  
5.207“  
13.23 cm  
Hinge Slot for  
optional Dress Panel  
13.23 cm  
5.207“  
4.535“  
11.52 cm  
1.00“ (2.54 cm)  
1.30“  
3.30 cm  
Figure 2.2 FACP Cabinet Mounting  
44  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mounting  
Installation  
Top  
Depth  
= 5.207" (13.23 cm)  
Depth =  
Door  
= 16.821" (42.73 cm)  
Backbox  
5.325"  
(13.526 cm)  
= 16.65" (42.29 cm)  
Door  
= 19.26" (48.92 cm)  
Backbox  
= 19.0" (48.26 cm)  
Left Side  
Right Side  
Bottom  
Figure 2.3 FACP Cabinet Dimensions  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Installation  
Power  
2.2 Power  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
!
SEVERAL DIFFERENT SOURCES OF POWER CAN BE CONNECTED TO THIS PANEL. DISCON-  
NECT ALL SOURCES OF POWER BEFORE SERVICING. THE PANEL AND ASSOCIATED  
EQUIPMENT MAY BE DAMAGED BY REMOVING AND/OR INSERTING CARDS, MODULES OR  
INTERCONNECTING CABLES WHILE THIS UNIT IS ENERGIZED.  
2.2.1 AC Power and Earth Ground Connection  
Primary power required for the FACP is 120 VAC, 60 Hz, 3.0 amps for  
the MS-9600LS(C) and MS-9600UDLS or 240 VAC, 50 Hz, 1.5 amps  
for the MS-9600LSE and MS-9600UDLSE. Overcurrent protection for  
this circuit must comply with Article 760 of the National Electrical  
Code (NEC) and/or local codes. Use 14 AWG (2.00 mm2) or larger  
wire with 600 volt insulation rating. Make certain that the AC mains  
circuit breaker is off before wiring any connections between the mains  
and the control panel. Connect wiring from the AC mains to TB1 on  
the FLPS-7 Power Supply, being careful to observe proper connections.  
120 VAC  
Hot L1  
EARTH  
Neut L2  
Illustration depicts connection of 120 VAC to TB1. Note that the FLPS-7 Power Supply is con-  
nected to the main circuit board by a cable connected to J1. Ensure that this cable is connected.  
Connect a wire from the grounding stud in the cabinet to a known solid earth ground (refer to Fig-  
ure 2.1 on page 43). This connection is vital for maintaining the control panel’s immunity to  
unwanted transients generated by lightning and electrostatic discharge. Apply AC power to the  
panel only after the system is completely installed and visually checked. Note that AC power must  
be applied to the panel before installing the battery interconnect cable (refer to the following sec-  
tion).  
2.2.2 Battery Power  
Before connecting the batteries to the FACP, make certain that  
the interconnect cable between the batteries is not connected.  
Do not connect the interconnect cable until the system is com-  
pletely installed. Observe polarity when connecting the batter-  
ies. Connect the battery cable to TB2 on the main circuit board.  
of the correct battery rating.  
Interconnect  
Cable  
WARNING: RISK OF PERSONAL INJURY  
!
BATTERY CONTAINS SULFURIC ACID WHICH CAN CAUSE SEVERE BURNS TO THE SKIN  
AND EYES AND CAN DESTROY FABRICS. IF CONTACT IS MADE WITH SULFURIC ACID,  
IMMEDIATELY FLUSH THE SKIN OR EYES WITH WATER FOR 15 MINUTES AND SEEK  
IMMEDIATE MEDICAL ATTENTION.  
46  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Relays  
Installation  
2.2.3 Special Application DC Power Output Connection  
All Special Application DC power outputs are power-limited.  
Power-limited Resettable Power  
Power-limited Nonresettable Power #1  
1.5 amperes max., 24 VDC nominal  
filtered, nonresettable power can be  
drawn from TB3 Terminals 3(+) and 4(-)  
Power-limited Nonresettable Power #2  
1.5 amperes max., 24 VDC nominal  
filtered, resettable power can be drawn  
from TB3 Terminals 1(+) and 2(-)  
1.5 amperes max. , 24 VDC nominal  
filtered, nonresettable power can be drawn  
from TB3 Terminals 5(+) and 6(-)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Figure 2.4 Special Application Power Outputs - 24 VDC  
2.3 Relays  
The FACP provides two programmable Form-C relays and one fixed fail-safe Form-C trouble  
relay, all with contacts rated for 2.0 amps @ 30 VDC (resistive) or 0.5 amps @ 30 VAC (resistive).  
The Alarm and Supervisory silk-screen labels reflect the factory default programming for the two  
programmable relays.  
Note that relay connections must be power-limited. Refer to Power-limited wiring requirements.  
Note that the relays labeled as Alarm  
Relay (Relay 1) and Supervisory Relay  
(Relay 3) reflect the factory default  
programming for these relays which are  
programmable.  
TB1  
TB5  
The relay labeled Trouble Relay (Relay 2)  
is fixed and cannot be changed. It is a fail-  
safe relay which will transfer on any trouble  
or total power failure.  
Relay contacts shown with power applied to panel  
and no active troubles, alarms or supervisories  
Figure 2.5 Relay Terminals  
2.4 Notification Appliance Circuits  
The control panel provides four Style Y/Class B or two Style Z/Class A NACs (Notification Appli-  
ance Circuits). Each circuit is capable of 3.0 amps of current. Total system current in alarm cannot  
VDC notification appliances only. Circuits are supervised and power-limited. Refer to the Device  
Compatibility Document for a listing of compatible notification appliances. The NACs, which are  
located on the main circuit board, may be expanded via the FCPS Series field charger/power sup-  
plies.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                                       
Installation  
Notification Appliance Circuits  
The following sections describe the configuration and wiring of Style Y and Style Z Notification  
Appliance Circuits on the FACP main circuit board. The NACs are configured for Style Y (Class  
B) from the factory. Refer to “Configuring NACs” on page 48 for information on changing the  
NAC configuration to Style Z (Class A) and preparing the NACKEY configuration card located in  
JP8, when installing a 4XTMF Transmitter Module.  
2.4.1 Configuring NACs  
The Notification Appliance Circuits on the main circuit board are configured for Style Y or Style Z  
by properly orienting the NACKEY card in JP8 which is located at the top of the main circuit board  
near the NAC Terminal TB4. The default configuration is for Style Y (Class B). Refer to Figure  
2.6 for information on installing the NACKEY card.  
NACKEY Card  
• Style Z (Class A) - install NACKEY into JP8  
C P A - E Y  
N A C K  
with Class A pointing down toward circuit board  
as illustrated to the right.  
• Style Y (Class B) - install NACKEY into JP8  
with Class B pointing down toward circuit board .  
B
C L A S S  
scored mark  
CLASS A  
NACKEY -PCA  
Key  
Key-slot  
NACKEY must be inserted with text side facing  
in toward center of main circuit board and key  
into key-slot as illustrated to the right. It is keyed  
to prevent incorrect insertion.  
JP8  
Top edge of FACP  
Main Circuit Board  
If the 4XTMF Option Module is to be installed in  
connectors J10 and J11, the NACKEY card must be  
carefully separated at the scored mark and only the  
required half installed into JP8. This will allow room  
for the 4XTMF module.  
TB4  
JP8  
NACKEY card slot  
4XTMF OPT BD  
4XTMF Module connectors  
J11  
J10  
connectors for 4XTMF option module  
Figure 2.6 NAC Configuration Using NACKEY  
48  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Notification Appliance Circuits  
Installation  
2.4.2 Style Y (Class B) NAC Wiring  
4 Style Y (Class B) Notification Appliance Circuits, supervised and power-limited - 4.7K ohm, ½ watt P/N:71252 UL-listed  
NAC 1  
NAC 3  
NAC 4  
NAC 2  
Polarized Bells  
Polarized Bells  
Polarized Strobes  
Polarized Horns  
Polarized Strobes  
Polarized Horns  
Notification Appliance Circuit  
polarity shown in alarm state  
Dummy Load all unused circuit  
circuit number  
TB4  
Figure 2.7 NAC Style Y (Class B) Wiring  
2.4.3 Style Z (Class A) NAC Wiring  
2 Style Z (Class A) Notification Appliance  
Circuits, supervised and power-limited  
Polarized Bell  
Polarized Bell  
Polarized Strobe  
Polarized Horn  
Polarized Strobe  
Polarized Horn  
Notification Appliance Circuit  
polarity shown in alarm state  
NAC 1  
NAC 2  
Figure 2.8 NAC Style Z (Class A) Wiring  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Installation  
Power-limited Wiring Requirements  
2.5 Power-limited Wiring Requirements  
Power-limited and nonpower-limited circuit wiring must remain separated in the cabinet. All  
power-limited circuit wiring must remain at least 0.25” (6.35 mm) away from any nonpower-lim-  
ited circuit wiring and nonpower-limited circuit wiring must enter and exit the cabinet through dif-  
ferent knockouts and/or conduits. A typical wiring diagram for the FACP is shown below.  
4XTMF  
SLC-2LS  
Figure 2.9 Typical Power-limited Wiring Requirements  
50  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Optional Modules and Devices  
Installation  
2.6 Optional Modules and Devices  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
DISCONNECT ALL SOURCES OF POWER (AC AND DC) BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING  
ANY MODULES OR WIRING.  
!
FACP Keypad/Display Removal  
Removal of the keypad/display is normally not necessary. If, however, it becomes necessary to  
replace the keypad/display, access the auxiliary trouble bus connectors at J16 and J17 or install the  
DACT-UD2 option module on J2, the Keypad/Display can be removed by inserting a Phillips  
screwdriver into each of the three holes located in the flexible covering of the Keypad/Display and  
loosening the three mounting screws. Note that it is not necessary to disconnect the cables between  
the Keypad/Display and the main circuit board unless the unit itself is being replaced. Carefully lift  
the Keypad/Display and rest the unit at the bottom of the main circuit board.  
NOTE: When installing the DACT-UD2, the main motherboard must be removed from the  
chassis. Unplug the power supply cable from J1 before proceeding.  
Keypad/DisplayMounting  
Screw Access Hole  
screw  
standoff  
standoff  
screw  
screw  
screw  
screw  
screw  
Keypad/Display Mounting  
Screw Access Holes  
Figure 2.10 Keypad/Display Removal  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Installation  
Optional Modules and Devices  
2.6.1 DACT-UD2 Installation  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
DISCONNECT ALL SOURCES OF POWER (AC AND DC) BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING  
ANY MODULES OR WIRING.  
!
The DACT-UD2 Digital Alarm Communicator/Transmitter, which is supplied standard with the  
MS-9600UDLS/E, transmits system status to UL listed Central Station receivers via the public  
switched telephone network. It is capable of reporting up to 99 software zones or up to 636  
addressable points. Two modular phone jacks, labeled PRI for Primary phone line and SEC for  
Secondary phone line, allow easy connection of two independent telephone lines to the DACT-  
UD2. The following functions have been incorporated into the DACT-UD2:  
Line Seizure - takes control of phone lines disconnecting any premises phones  
Off/On Hook - performs on and off-hook status to the phone lines  
Listen for dial tone - 440 hertz tone typical in most networks  
Dialing Central Station(s) number - default is Touch-Tone®, programmable to rotary  
For tone burst or touchtone type formats: determine proper ‘Acknowledge’ and ‘Kissoff’  
tone(s) - the frequency and time duration of the tone(s) varies with the transmission format.  
The control panel will adjust accordingly  
Communicate in the following formats:  
• Ademco Contact ID  
• SIA  
The DACT-UD2 module plugs into connector J2 on the FACP main circuit board.  
PRI  
SEC  
Primary Phone Line  
Secondary Phone Line  
J5 Connector (located on  
back of module) plugs into J2  
on FACP main circuit board  
J4  
USB Port  
Figure 2.11 DACT-UD2 Module  
52  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Optional Modules and Devices  
Installation  
The following steps must be followed when installing the DACT-UD2 module:  
1. Remove all power (AC and DC) from FACP before proceeding with installation  
2. Remove all main circuit board mounting screws (6 locations) and the 4XTMF module  
standoffs (2 locations), unplug the power supply cable from J1 and lift the main circuit board  
assembly off the chassis (refer to Figure 2.10)  
3. Remove the Keypad/Display from the main circuit board as described in the beginning of this  
section  
4. Remove and discard the Keypad/Display support standoff that presently occupies DACT-UD2  
standoff location #3 (refer to Figure 2.12)  
5. Install the supplied DACT-UD2 female/female standoffs in the three locations shown in Figure  
2.12 and secure with the three supplied screws, inserted from the bottom side of the main  
circuit board. Be sure to tighten them fully.  
6. Carefully plug connector J5 on back of the DACT-UD2 module into connector J2 on the FACP  
main circuit board, being careful not to bend any pins  
7. Align the mounting holes in the DACT-UD2 module with the newly installed standoffs on the  
FACP main circuit board  
Standoff 1  
Standoff 2  
Standoff 3  
J5  
J2  
J1 Connector located on  
back of DACT-UD2 module  
Figure 2.12 DACT-UD2 J1 Connector to FACP J2 Connector  
Secure the module to the standoffs on the main circuit board with two of the screws supplied with the DACT-UD2 and the supplied male/female standoff which becomes the new Keypad/Display support in that location see Figure 2.13)  
(
NOTE: It is important that the supplied hardware be used to secure the module in order to help  
protect against electrical transients.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation  
Optional Modules and Devices  
Mounting Screw  
Mounting Screw  
male/female standoff  
Figure 2.13 DACT-UD2 Installation on Standoffs  
8. Reinstall Keypad/Display on the main circuit board by positioning the unit over the  
appropriate standoffs and securing with screws which were loosened in step 3  
9. Remount the main circuit board assembly to the chassis using screws and standoffs in their  
original locations. Plug in the power supply cable at J1 on the main circuit board  
10. Make certain to program the control panel for DACT-UD2 operation  
11. Refer to the Telephone Requirement and Warnings section of the DACT-UD2 Installation and  
Programming Manual Document #53037, before proceeding with this step. Connect the  
premises primary and secondary phone lines to the DACT-UD2 as illustrated in Figure 2.14  
and test the system for correct operation  
54  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Optional Modules and Devices  
Installation  
Primary Lines  
Secondary Lines  
Incoming Telco Phone  
Lines  
Incoming Telco  
Phone Lines  
Green Wire  
Red Wire  
Ring  
Tip  
Green Wire  
Red Wire  
Tip  
Ring  
To premises phones  
Tip  
Ring  
To premises phones  
Ring  
Tip  
Note: Shorting bars inside RJ31X Jack  
removed during male plug insertion  
Secondary Phone Line SEC  
7 foot cable  
(MCBL-7)  
Primary Phone Line PRI  
order separately  
Male Plug  
Connectors  
CAUTION: It is critical that the  
DACT-UD2 be located as the first  
device on the incoming telephone  
circuit to properly function  
Female  
Connectors  
DACT-UD2  
Figure 2.14 Wiring Phone Jacks  
2.6.2 4XTMF Transmitter Module Installation  
The 4XTMF provides a supervised output for a local energy municipal box transmitter in addition  
to alarm and trouble reverse polarity. A jumper option allows the reverse polarity circuit to open  
with a system trouble condition if no alarm condition exists. A disable switch allows disabling of  
the transmitter output during testing to prevent accidental calling of the monitoring service.  
Local Energy Municipal Box Service (NFPA 72 Auxiliary Fire Alarm Systems):  
Supervisory Current: 5.0 mA  
Trip Current: 350 mA (subtracted from notification appliance power)  
Coil Voltage: 3.65 VDC  
Maximum Coil Resistance: 14.6 ohms  
Maximum allowable wire resistance between panel and trip coil: 3 ohms  
Municipal Box wiring can leave the building  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Installation  
Optional Modules and Devices  
Remote Station Service (NFPA 72 Remote Station Fire Alarm Systems) - Intended for connec-  
tion to a polarity reversal circuit or a Remote Station receiving unit having compatible rat-  
ings:  
Maximum load for each circuit: 10 mA  
Reverse polarity output voltage: 24 VDC  
Remote Alarm and Remote Trouble wiring can leave the building  
Before installing the module, place the disconnect switch to the right (disconnect) position to pre-  
vent accidental activation of the municipal box. Note that a Disconnect LED will illuminate after  
the module is installed in the FACP. In addition, the System Trouble LED will turn on to indicate  
the Disconnect condition.  
Note: 4XTMF Module is not suitable for transmitting reverse  
polarity supervisory signal.  
Remote Alarm (power-limited)*  
* Wiring from these terminals  
can exit the protected  
premises. Dummy load  
terminals 6 and 7 (4.7K, ¼  
watt resistor) if Municipal Box  
Remote Trouble (power-limited)*  
No connection  
is not connected.  
Municipal Box (nonpower-limited)*  
+ - + -  
+ -  
Polarities are shown for module activation  
Disconnect LED  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7  
Disconnect Switch  
shown in disconnect  
position  
TBL Jumper  
Connect to FACP J10 & J11  
Figure 2.15 4XTMF Transmitter Module  
The following steps must be followed when installing the 4XTMF module:  
1. Remove all power (AC and DC) from the FACP before installing 4XTMF  
2. Cut jumper JP6 on the main circuit board to allow the control panel to supervise the 4XTMF  
module  
3. The NACKEY Card must be separated at the score mark to allow connection of the 4XTMF  
module (refer to Figure 2.6 on page 48 for complete information)  
4. Carefully plug the connectors on the 4XTMF module into connectors J10 and J11 on the FACP  
main circuit board, being careful not to bend any pins  
5. Secure 4XTMF module to standoffs with supplied screws.  
6. Reapply power to the FACP  
7. For proper 4XTMF operation, the output relays must be programmed for the factory default  
settings as shown on the PC board silkscreen: Alarm Relay, Trouble Relay and Supervisory  
Relay  
56  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Optional Modules and Devices  
Installation  
8. When the installation has been complete, enable the 4XTMF module by sliding the disconnect  
switch to the left  
9. Test system for proper operation  
Standoff  
Standoff  
Cut Jumper JP6  
J10 & J11 Connectors  
4XTMF  
FACP  
Figure 2.16 4XTMF Connectors to FACP Connectors  
NOTE: Jumper JP5 on the FACP main circuit board can be used to configure the FACP  
supervisory relay for operation with the 4XTMF module. The supervisory relay must be  
programmed as shown on the main circuit board silk-screen (TB5, Terminals 4, 5 & 6).  
Cutting JP5 will allow the 4XTMF to generate a trouble if the supervisory contact opens  
Leaving JP5 in will prevent generation of a trouble if the supervisory contact opens  
2.6.3 Auxiliary Trouble Input (J16 & J17)  
Auxiliary Trouble Inputs 1 (J17) and 2 (J16), which are located on the FACP main circuit board,  
can be used to monitor for trouble conditions on auxiliary equipment such as power supplies. J16  
and/or J17 can be connected to any open collector trouble output on the auxiliary equipment. The  
control panel will indicate a trouble condition if a trouble is sensed at the Auxiliary Trouble Inputs.  
If the 4XTMF Module is installed and FACP jumper JP6 has been cut to supervise it, Auxiliary  
Trouble Input 1 (J17) will monitor the 4XTMF for trouble conditions.  
2.6.4 SLC-2LS Expander Module  
The optional SLC-2LS Expander Module provides a second SLC loop for the FACP control panel.  
This allows connection of an additional 318 addressable devices, bringing the total to 636 address-  
able devices which can be connected to the FACP. Refer to the SLC Wiring Manual for informa-  
tion on connecting devices to the SLC.  
IMPORTANT! When SLC wiring is run in conduit, each SLC loop must be installed in separate  
conduit.  
The following steps must be followed when installing the SLC-2LS Expander Module:  
1. Remove all power (AC and DC) from the FACP before installing the SLC-2LS module  
2. Remove four screws from main FACP motherboard, from locations indicated in following  
illustration, and replace with four supplied metal standoffs  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Installation  
Optional Modules and Devices  
3. Carefully plug connector J3 on the SLC-2LS module into connector J3 on the  
MS-9600LS/MS-9600UDLS main circuit board, being careful not to bend any pins  
4. Secure the SLC-2LS Expander Module to the four standoffs installed in step 2 with the four  
supplied screws (or the screws removed in step 2)  
5. Connect the SLC wiring and devices to TB8 on the SLC Expander Module. Refer to the SLC  
Wiring Manual for wiring information  
6. Reapply power to the control panel  
7. Program the addressable devices connected to the SLC-2LS Expander Module as detailed in  
8. Test the system for proper operation  
SLC Loop 1  
SLC Loop 2  
Shield B  
Shield A  
SLC A-  
Shield B  
Shield A  
SLC A-  
SLC B-  
SLC A+  
SLC B+  
SLC B-  
SLC A+  
SLC B+  
Remove four screws and replace  
with four supplied metal standoffs  
SLC-2LS Expander Module  
FACP  
Figure 2.17 SLC-2LS Expander Module Installation  
2.6.5 Printer/PC  
A serial printer or a PC (personal computer) may be connected to TB7 Terminals 1 - 4 on the FACP.  
The printer can be used to provide a hard-copy printout of real-time events, history file and walktest  
data. An IBM compatible PC can be connected to provide local FACP programming capabilities  
using the PS-Tools programming utility. Installation of either device requires panel programming  
to allow the FACP to communicate with the device.  
A parallel printer may also be connected to the FACP using the optional ANN-S/PG Serial/Parallel  
58  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Optional Modules and Devices  
installation details. Refer to “ANN-BUS Options” on page 121 for programming information.  
CAUTION: POSSIBLE EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
Installation  
!
DO NOT CONNECT A PRINTER OR PC TO THE FACP IF A GROUND FAULT (ZERO IMPED-  
ANCE TO GROUND) EXISTS ON THE CONTROL PANEL. CIRCUIT DAMAGE MAY RESULT.  
REMOVE ALL POWER (AC AND DC) BEFORE INSTALLING OR REMOVING ANY WIRING.  
Installation  
Remote printers and PCs require separate primary power. Also required is the PRT/PK-CABLE  
which is an interface cable prewired to a DB9F connector. Wire the PRT/PK-CABLE to TB7 Ter-  
minals 1 - 4 as illustrated in the following figure. Connect the DB9F connector to the printer or PC  
serial EIA-232 port. If a nine-pin serial connector is not available on the printer or PC, use a DB25  
adapter. Make certain that the DB25 adapter does not swap the Transmit and Receive lines. Apply  
power to the FACP and printer or PC. Note that a ground fault (zero impedance to ground) may  
occur on the FACP, dependent on the printer or PC being used, due to this connection. For this rea-  
son, it is important that there be no preexisting ground fault on the panel.  
Note that the printer may or may not be supervised as determined by user programming. Refer to  
Red  
5
4
3
2
1
White  
Green  
Black  
9
8
7
6
PRT/PK-CABLE  
TX  
RCV  
DTR  
GRND  
RS-232 PC/PRINTER  
XMT RCV DTR GRND  
SLC  
SLC  
ACS  
COMM  
SHIELD  
1
2
B+ A+ B- A-  
B
A
T
B
6
T
B
8
T
B
7
Figure 2.18 Serial Printer and Computer Connections  
Printer Configuration  
Refer to the documentation supplied with the printer for pertinent information about printer setup.  
Set the printer’s options as listed in the following table:  
COMMUNICATION SETUP  
BUFFER:  
DATA BITS:  
LARGE  
7
EVEN  
PARITY:  
STOP BIT:  
1 STOP  
2400/4800/9600  
NO  
BAUD RATE:  
AUTOMATIC LINE FEED  
AUTOMATIC CARRIAGE RETURN  
NO  
PC Configuration  
The Windows-based PK-CD Programming Utility Kit contains a CD-ROM with on-line help file.  
2.6.6 Annunciators  
Legacy ACM-8RF Relay Control Module  
The ACM-8RF module provides eight Form-C relays with contacts rated for 5 amps.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Installation  
Optional Modules and Devices  
Legacy ACM Series Annunciators  
ACM and AFM Series Annunciators provide visual indications of FACP status in remote locations.  
Refer to the appropriate annunciator manual for information on installation, wiring and operation.  
60  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Section 3: Programming  
3.1 Programming Data Entry  
Programming can be accomplished using the FACP keypad or by connecting an optional standard  
computer keyboard. The keyboard can be connected to the PS-2 connector J7 on the control panel  
main circuit board.  
Local or remote programming and editing can also be accomplished using the DACT-UD2 Digital  
Alarm Communicator/Transmitter which is optional for the MS-9600LS and supplied standard  
with the MS-9600UDLS. Refer to the DACT-UD2 Manual P/N 53037 for detailed information.  
The information presented in this section refers to programming the FACP via the onboard keypad.  
If an optional computer keyboard is connected to the FACP main circuit board, the following table  
describes the keyboard keys which correspond to the onboard keypad keys.  
Keypad Keys  
Computer Keyboard Keys  
1st Event  
Home  
Delete  
Esc  
Insert  
*
CLR  
ESC  
RECALL  
*
#
#
A - Z  
A - Z  
0 - 9  
Space bar  
0 - 9  
(on QZ key)  
/
/
ENTER  
ACK/STEP  
SILENCE  
DRILL  
RESET  
Enter  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Programming  
User Programming  
3.2 User Programming  
The FACP is completely field programmable and requires no special software skills. While pro-  
gramming the FACP, the fire protection capabilities of the control panel are enabled. Program-  
ming mode will time-out following 10 minutes of inactivity.  
Site-specific programming may be accomplished in three ways:  
Autoprogramming Feature - This is a convenient method for quickly bringing the FACP  
addressable SLC devices on-line without the necessity of programming each device  
individually. Refer to “Autoprogram” on page 66 for a detailed description of  
Autoprogramming  
Manual programming or editing, using the FACP keypad or a PC keyboard  
Remote Programming and Editing Feature - allows creation and editing of site-specific custom  
programs using a Windows-based computer and modem. For programs requiring a large  
amount of data entry, this method may be preferred. A PK-CD programming CD-ROM can be  
ordered for this purpose  
Local Programming and Editing Feature - allows creation and editing of site-specific custom  
programs using a Windows-based computer and the DACT-UD2 USB connection on the  
MS-9600UDLS or Serial Port connection on TB7 of the MS-9600LS. For programs requiring  
a large amount of data entry, this method may be preferred. A PK-CD programming CD-ROM  
can be ordered for this purpose  
The System All Normal screen will be displayed in a programmed system with no active alarms,  
troubles or supervisories, as illustrated below:  
SYSTEM ALL NORMAL  
10:00A 010807  
Read Status mode can be entered while the panel is in any mode of operation. If an alarm or super-  
visory event exists at the panel, the event must be cleared before entering Programming mode. To  
access any of the programming or read status features, the Enter or Mode key must be pressed,  
which will cause the LCD to display the following:  
1=READ STATUS  
2=PROGRAMMING  
3=REMOTE DOWNLOAD  
Pressing 1, while this screen is being displayed, will cause the control panel to enter the Read Sta-  
tus feature which allows the user to view the programmed features and status of the control panel  
The Read Status feature is not password protected. Refer to “Read Status” on page 160 for a  
detailed description of this feature.  
Pressing 2 will select user Programming which may only be accomplished by an authorized person.  
After pressing 2, a screen will prompt for a password. After entering the correct password, the user  
may select from a list of programming options.  
Pressing 3 will select Remote Download which allows the user to enable the remote programming  
option. Refer to the DACT-UD2 manual P/N 53037.  
62  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Initial Power-up  
Programming  
Exit Programming or Read Status  
The programmer can exit Read Status or Programming mode by repeatedly pressing the keypad  
ESC (Escape) key until the display reads System All Normal. Ten minutes of inactivity will also  
cause the FACP to exit Programming mode. Note that the data which is entered during Program-  
ming mode is not saved until the programmer exits this mode by repeatedly pressing the ‘ESC’ key.  
If the Reset key is pressed or power is lost before exiting Programming mode, all data which was  
just entered will be lost.  
User Programming Levels  
There are two user programming levels:  
User Master Program Level 1 is used for programming panel specific data relating to device  
types, zoning, messages, control panel functions, etc.  
User Maintenance Program Level 2 is used by a qualified operator to access features such as  
Disable/Enable, View and Clear History, Walktest and System Time Change.  
3.3 Initial Power-up  
The following sections describe the initial programming procedures for a new system. The same  
procedures are used to modify programming in an existing system.  
After completing the wiring of addressable devices to the SLC, apply power to the control panel. If  
the addressable devices have not yet been programmed into the FACP, their LEDs will not flash and  
the following trouble message will be displayed.  
TROUBL IN SYSTEM  
NO DEVICES INSTALLED  
09:03A 020410  
3.4 Programming Screens Description  
The main options available when the Enter key is pressed are: Read Status, Programming Mode.  
Each option has multiple functions or features which may be chosen. To view all of the choices, it  
is necessary that the programmer scroll through a number of additional subscreens. These selec-  
tions are displayed on multiple screens to make them more readable for the programmer. Refer to  
“Master Programming Level” on page 65, for additional information on the various screens.  
The title of the main option screen will always be displayed at the top of the subscreens for the pro-  
grammer’s convenience. If additional subscreens exist, an Up or Down arrow will be displayed in  
the upper right corner of the screen being viewed. The programmer can then press the keypad Up  
or Down arrow key to view the new subscreen. To select one of the choices in a screen, the pro-  
grammer presses the keypad numerical key corresponding to the desired choice.  
Note that subscreens may also have multiple options which require viewing more than one screen.  
The same process, as detailed in the previous paragraphs, is followed to view all option choices.  
3.5 Programming and Passwords  
There are two factory set programming passwords which will access the Programming screens as  
indicated in the following examples. From either of the screens, access to specific system and  
device features or programming may be obtained. All user programming entries are stored in non-  
volatile memory. The factory set passwords can be changed by the user as described in “Password  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
Programming  
Programming and Passwords  
Change” on page 135. If an invalid password is entered, the blinking cursor will return to the first  
password character position. To exit Programming or Read Status mode at any time, press the ESC  
(Escape) key repeatedly. Note that Programming mode must be exited using the ESC key in order  
to store the program data entered during this mode. If the Reset key is pressed or power is lost  
before exiting Programming mode, the data just entered will not be saved.  
To access user Programming mode, press the Enter or Mode key. The LCD will display the follow-  
ing:  
1=READ STATUS  
2=PROGRAMMING  
3=REMOTE DOWNLOAD  
To enter the user Programming mode, press 2. The display will read as follows:  
PROGRAMMING  
ENTER PASSWORD  
*****  
Entering the Master level password (default 00000) will cause the following screen to appear:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=AUTOPROGRAM  
2=POINT PROGRAM  
3=ZONE SETUP  
If the Maintenance level password (default 11111) is entered, the following screen will appear:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=POINT PROGRAM  
2=HISTORY  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
Note that in the two preceding screens, an arrow appears to inform the programmer that additional  
options can be viewed by pressing the keypad down arrow key.  
64  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
3.6 Master Programming Level  
When the Master Program Level password is entered, the control panel will enter user Program-  
ming mode. In this mode, the piezo sounder remains off, the trouble relay is activated and the sys-  
tem Trouble LED flashes until Programming mode is exited. The following display will appear:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=AUTOPROGRAM  
2=POINT PROGRAM  
3=ZONE SETUP  
Programming Screen #1  
The down arrow which appears in the display indicates that additional programming choices can be  
viewed by pressing the down arrow key on the keypad. If a down and up arrow appear in the dis-  
play, pressing the ‘down’ arrow key will display the subsequent Programming Screens as illustrated  
below while pressing the ‘up’ arrow key will display the previous screen.  
PROGRAMMING  
1=LOOP SETUP  
2=SYSTEM SETUP  
3=VERIFY LOOPS  
Programming Screen #2  
PROGRAMMING  
1=HISTORY  
2=WALKTEST  
3=OPTION MODULES  
Programming Screen #3  
PROGRAMMING  
1=PASSWORD CHANGE  
2=CLEAR PROGRAM  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
Programming Screen #4  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
3.6.1 Autoprogram  
PROGRAMMING  
Pressing 1 while viewing Programming Screen #1, will select the Autoprogram option, which  
prompts the control panel to poll all devices installed on one or both SLC loops. The primary pur-  
pose of autoprogramming is to allow the installer a fast and easy way to bring the system on-line as  
quickly as possible. The first time the system is powered-up, it should be autoprogrammed.  
1=AUTOPROGRAM  
2=POINT PROGRAM  
3=ZONE SETUP  
Programming Screen #1  
If the system is already programmed and Autoprogram is initiated, the system will only add default  
values for newly installed devices.  
When Autoprogram is selected, the programmer is given the option of autoprogramming all loops,  
only loop 1 or only loop 2. The following will be displayed on the LCD:  
AUTOPROGRAM  
1=LOOP 1  
2=LOOP 2  
3=ALL LOOPS  
Autoprogram Loop Select Screen  
After selecting one of the Autoprogram options, the control panel will begin autoprogramming the  
system by communicating with each addressable device installed on one or both loops. While auto-  
programming, the panel will display the following:  
AUTOPROGRAM  
AUTOPROGRAMMING!  
PLEASE WAIT  
Autoprogram Progress Screen  
When Autoprogramming is completed, the control panel will display the type and quantity of each  
device installed on the SLC loop(s) similar to the following display:  
# OF DET LOOP1 055  
# OF MON LOOP1 035  
# OF CON LOOP1 030  
Autoprogram Result Screen #1  
# OF DET LOOP2 000  
# OF MON LOOP2 000  
# OF CON LOOP2 000  
Autoprogram Result Screen #2  
In the preceding example, the first display indicates that Loop 1 has 55 addressable detectors, 35  
monitor modules and 30 control modules installed. The second display indicates that Loop 2 has  
no devices installed.  
66  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
3.6.2 Point Program  
PROGRAMMING  
1=AUTOPROGRAM  
2=POINT PROGRAM  
3=ZONE SETUP  
The Point Program option allows the programmer to add a new addressable device to an SLC loop,  
delete an existing device from a loop or change the programming for an existing device. Pressing  
2, while viewing Programming Screen #1, will select the Point Program option and display the fol-  
lowing screen:  
Programming Screen #1  
POINT PROGRAM  
SELECT LOOP  
1=LOOP 1  
2=LOOP 2  
Point Program Screen #1  
The programmer selects the desired SLC loop by pressing 1 or 2 in Point Program Screen #1,  
which causes the panel to display the following screen:  
POINT PROGRAM  
SELECT TYPE  
1=DETECTOR  
2=MODULE  
Point Program Screen #2  
Detector Programming  
Pressing 1, while viewing Point Program Screen #2, will allow the programmer to add, delete or  
change the programming of an addressable detector. The following screen will be displayed by the  
control panel:  
DETECTOR  
1=ADD  
2=DELETE  
3=EDIT  
Detector Screen  
Add Detector  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Detector Screen will display the following screen which allows the  
programmer to add a new detector address to programming:  
ADD DETECTOR  
ENTER DETECTOR#  
***  
Add Detector Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left. The programmer keys in  
the three digit detector address, such as 005.  
When the last digit is keyed-in, the following screen will be displayed:  
DETECTOR TYPE  
1=SMOKE(PHOTO)  
2=USER-DEFINED-1  
3=SMOKE(ION)  
Press the down arrow key to view additional choices. Press the number corresponding to the  
desired selection to program that type to the newly added detector.  
When the type has been selected, the following screen will be displayed:  
ADD DETECTOR  
DETECTOR#  
IS ADDED  
005  
The programmer can continue adding detectors by pressing the ESC or left arrow key which will  
return the display to the Add Detector Screen.  
Delete Detector  
Pressing 2 in the Detector Screen will display the Delete Detector Screen which allows the pro-  
grammer to delete a specific detector:  
DETECTOR  
1=ADD  
2=DELETE  
3=EDIT  
DELETE DETECTOR  
ENTER DETECTOR#  
***  
Detector Screen  
Delete Detector Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left. The programmer keys in  
the three digit detector address, such as 005. When the last digit is keyed-in, the following screen  
will be displayed:  
DELETE DETECTOR  
DETECTOR#  
IS DELETED  
005  
The programmer can continue deleting detectors by pressing the ESC or left arrow key which will  
return the display to the Delete Detector Screen.  
68  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Edit Detector  
Programming  
The programmer can change a detectors existing or factory default programming by pressing 3 in  
the Detector Screen. The following screen will be displayed:  
EDIT DETECTOR  
ENTER POINT ADDRESS  
***  
Edit Detector Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left. The programmer keys in  
the three digit detector address, such as 017.  
When the last digit is keyed-in, if the selected address has not been added to programming, a screen  
showing information about a device that is installed with a lower address, closest to the selected  
address, will be displayed.  
If no detectors have been installed on the loop, the following will be displayed:  
NO DETECTOR  
INSTALLED  
Edit Detector Screen #1  
If the selected address has been added to programming, device summary screens will be displayed.  
These screens allow the programmer to view all device settings at a single glance. Pressing the left  
or right arrow keys will allow the programmer to rapidly view the devices at the previous or next  
address (if installed).  
If a detector (such as a photoelectric detector) with the selected address is not physically installed  
on the SLC or has a communication fault but the address is programmed in the system, the follow-  
ing screen will be displayed:  
TROUBL SMOKE(PHOTO)  
********************  
ZNNN  
* 1D017  
Edit Detector Screen #1  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
If the selected address has been added to programming and a detector (such as a photoelectric  
detector) with the selected address is physically installed on the SLC and is communicating with  
the control panel, the following will be displayed:  
NORMAL SMOKE (PHOTO)  
*********************  
ZNNN  
V 1D017  
Edit Detector Screen #1  
To change the programming for the displayed detector, press the keyboard ‘down’ arrow key to  
view the Edit Detector screens.  
In the preceding example:  
• Normal - indicates that the detector with the selected address is physically installed on the  
SLC and communicating with the control panel (enabled)  
• <ADJ><NOUN> - represents the adjective and noun, which have been programmed,  
describing the location of the displayed device  
• ZNNN - represents the first of five possible software zones that the detector is assigned to  
(NNN = the three digit zone number from 000 - 099)  
• V or * - indicates whether or not alarm verification is enabled (V = alarm verification  
enabled and * = alarm verification disabled)  
• 1D017 - represents the Loop, Device type and Device address (1 = SLC Loop 1, D=Detector  
and 017 = Detector Address 017)  
70  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
The following examples show the editing of a photoelectric smoke detector with address 017,  
located on the first SLC loop:  
EDIT DETECTOR 1D017  
1=ENABLED YES  
2=TYPE SMOKE(PHOTO)  
3=VERIFICATION OFF  
Edit Detector Screen #2  
EDIT DETECTOR 1D017  
1=WALKTEST  
2=PAS  
3=PRE-SIGNAL  
NO  
NO  
NO  
Edit Detector Screen #3  
EDIT DETECTOR 1D017  
1=ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
00 ** ** ** **  
Edit Detector Screen #4  
EDIT DETECTOR 1D017  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
********************  
Edit Detector Screen #5  
Enable/Disable Detector  
To Enable or Disable the detector, press the 1 key while viewing the Edit Detector Screen #2. Each  
press of the key will toggle the screen between Enabled Yes and Enabled No. If Enabled No is  
selected, the detector will not be polled by the control panel, preventing the detector from reporting  
alarms and troubles to the panel. The control panel will display the device type and address which  
has been disabled and will turn on the Trouble LED and Disable LED.  
EDIT DETECTOR  
1=ENABLED  
2=TYPE  
3=VERIFICATION  
Edit Detector Screen #2  
Type  
To select the type of detector being programmed, press the 2 key while viewing the Edit Detector  
Screen #2. This will cause the control panel to display the following Detector Type Screens:  
DETECTOR TYPE  
1=SMOKE PHOTO  
2=USER DEFINED-1  
3=SMOKE (ION)  
Detector Type Screen #1  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing the down arrow key will display additional detector types as indicated in the following  
table:  
Detector Type  
Smoke Photo  
User-Defined-1  
Smoke Ion  
Action When Activated  
Fire Alarm  
same as previous (Smoke Photo)  
Fire Alarm  
User-Defined-2  
Heat Detect  
same as previous (Smoke Ion)  
Fire Alarm  
User-Defined-3  
Smoke DuctP  
User-Defined-4  
Photo w/Heat  
User-Defined-5  
Duct-Superv  
User-Defined-6  
Photo-SupervAR  
User-Defined-7  
ADAPT  
same as previous (Heat Detect)  
Fire Alarm  
same as previous (Smoke DuctP)  
Fire Alarm  
same as previous (Photo w/Heat)  
Supervisory, latching  
same as previous (Superv DuctP)  
Supervisory, nonlatching (works only in LiteSpeed)  
same as previous (Photo-SupervAR)  
Fire Alarm  
User-Defined-8  
Beam  
same as previous (ADAPT)  
Fire Alarm  
User-Defined-9  
same as previous (Beam)  
While viewing any Detector Type screen, select the type of detector being programmed by pressing  
the corresponding keyboard number key. The display will return to Edit Detector Screen #2 and  
indicate the selection next to the Type option.  
NOTE: If a detector is selected as a SUPERV DUCTP type, it will function like a supervisory point,  
not a fire alarm point. The supervisory LED and supervisory relay will activate, not the fire alarm LED  
or alarm relay, if smoke is sensed.  
Verification  
Alarm verification is used to confirm that a smoke detector activation is a true alarm condition and  
not a false alarm. This feature is selected by pressing 3 while viewing the Edit Detector Screen #2  
so that the display reads Verification On. Each time the 3 key is pressed, the display will toggle  
between Verification On and Verification Off. For a detailed description, refer to “Alarm Verifica-  
Walktest  
The Walktest feature allows one person to test the system devices without the necessity of manually  
resetting the control panel after each device activation. To enable a device for the Walktest feature,  
press 1 while viewing the Edit Detector Screen #3 until the display reads Walktest Yes. Each press  
of the 1 key will cause the display to toggle between Walktest Yes and Walktest No. Refer to “Walk-  
EDIT DETECTOR  
1=WALKTEST  
2=PAS  
3=PRE-SIGNAL  
Edit Detector Screen #3  
PAS  
The PAS (Positive Alarm Sequence) option will program the detector to delay panel activation  
(including alarm relay and communicator) for a period of 15 seconds plus a programmable time of  
up to 3 minutes. Zone 97, however, will activate immediately and may be used to connect a signal-  
ing device to indicate PAS activation (do not use a Notification Appliance Circuit for this purpose).  
To enable the PAS feature, press 2 while viewing the Edit Detector Screen #3 until the display reads  
PAS Yes. Each press of the 2 key will cause the display to toggle between PAS Yes and PAS No.  
For example, if a detector with address 005 is to be configured for PAS operation:  
• Select PAS Yes when editing the detector set to address 005  
72  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
• Program the desired zone or zones to be activated by this detector, in this example Z001  
• Program an output, such as a control module that is to be activated by detector 005 by  
assigning the same zone to it; in this example Z001  
• Program an output, such as a control module, for PAS activation by assigning zone Z97 to it.  
This control module may be connected to a signaling device used to indicate a PAS  
condition (do not use a Notification Appliance Circuit for this purpose)  
• Enable zones Z001 and Special Purpose Zone PAS 97 and set the PAS delay timer to some  
value  
With the preceding program settings, when the detector with address 005 is activated, zone Z97  
will cause its associated control module to activate immediately, sounding the connected PAS sig-  
naling device. Following the PAS delay time, zone Z001 will cause its associated control module  
to activate and the control panel will initiate an alarm condition.  
Note that a detector can be enabled for either PAS or Pre-signal but not both.  
Pre-signal  
The Pre-signal option programs the detector to delay panel activation for a preprogrammed time  
delay of up to three minutes while allowing for visual verification by a person. Note that the alarm  
relay and communicator will respond to the initial alarm immediately. In addition, Zone 98 will  
activate. This zone can be programmed to a control module which may be used to activate a  
sounder or indicator which the installer designates as a Presignal indication (do not use a Notifica-  
tion Appliance Circuit for this purpose). To enable the Pre-signal feature, press 3 while viewing  
Edit Detector Screen #3 until the display reads Pre-signal Yes. Each press of the 3 key will cause  
the display to toggle between Pre-signal Yes and Pre-signal No. Refer to “Presignal” on page 158.  
EDIT DETECTOR  
1=WALKTEST  
2=PAS  
3=PRE-SIGNAL  
Edit Detector Screen #3  
For example, if a detector with address 005 is to be configured for Pre-Signal operation:  
• Select Pre-signal Yes when editing the detector set to address 005.  
• Program the desired zone or zones to be activated by this detector, in this example Z001.  
• Program an output, such as a control module that is to be activated by detector 005 by  
assigning the same zone to it; in this example Z001.  
• Program an output, such as a control module, for Pre-signal activation by assigning zone  
Z98 to it. This control module may be connected to a signaling device used to indicate a  
Pre-signal condition (do not use a Notification Appliance Circuit for this purpose).  
• Enable zones Z001 and Special Purpose Zone Pre-signal 98 and set the Pre-signal delay  
timer to some value.  
With the preceding program settings, when the detector with address 005 is activated, zone Z98  
will cause its associated control module to activate immediately, sounding the connected signaling  
device to indicate the Pre-signal condition. Following the Pre-signal delay time, zone Z001 will  
cause its associated control module to activate and the control panel will initiate an alarm condition.  
Note that a detector can be enabled for either PAS or Pre-signal but not both.  
Zone Assignment  
A maximum of five zones can be programmed to each addressable detector. Pressing 1 while view-  
ing Edit Detector Screen #4 displays the following screen:  
EDIT DETECTOR  
1=ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
00 ** ** ** **  
ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Z00 Z** Z** Z** Z**  
Edit Detector Screen #4  
Zone Assignment Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Note that Z** represents the Zone Number(s) corresponding to this device. The factory default for  
an unprogrammed device is Z00 for general alarm zone. A flashing cursor will appear on the first 0  
to the left. Enter the two digit number corresponding to the zone that is to be assigned to this  
device. The cursor moves to the next Z** designation. Continue entering zone assignments or the  
remaining zones can be left blank or programmed as general alarm zone Z00. When all desired  
changes have been made, press the Enter key to store the zone assignments. The display will return  
to the Edit Detector Screen #4. Note that the left and right arrow keys can be used to navigate  
through the zones and the CLEAR key can be used to quickly clear a zone.  
Noun/Adjective  
The Noun/Adjective selection allows the programmer to enter specific descriptors about the detec-  
tor currently being programmed. Pressing 1 while viewing Edit Detector Screen #5 will cause the  
following screen to be displayed:  
EDIT DETECTOR  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
*****************  
Edit Detector Screen #5  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
74  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will cause the following screen(s) to be dis-  
played. Note that the keyboard down arrow key must be pressed to see all the Adjective screens.  
Press the number corresponding to the adjective that is to be used as a descriptor for the location of  
the detector currently being programmed. When an adjective has been selected, it will appear at the  
top of the display as indicated by the asterisks.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
**********************  
1=WEST  
2=FRONT  
**********************  
1=NORTH  
2=SOUTH  
3=EAST  
3=CENTER  
Adjective Screen #2  
Adjective Screen #1  
*********************  
1=MAIN  
2=FIRST  
**********************  
1=REAR  
2=UPPER  
3=2ND  
3=LOWER  
Adjective Screen #4  
Adjective Screen #3  
**********************  
1=3RD  
2=4TH  
**********************  
1=FLOOR1  
2=FLOOR2  
3=5TH  
3=FLOOR3  
Adjective Screen #5  
Adjective Screen #6  
**********************  
1=FLOOR4  
2=FLOOR5  
3=ROOM  
Adjective Screen #7  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will cause the following screen(s) to be dis-  
played. Note that the keyboard down arrow key must be pressed to see all the Noun screens. Press  
the number corresponding to the noun that is to be used as a descriptor for the location of the detec-  
tor currently being programmed. When a noun has been selected, it will appear at the top of the  
display as indicated by the asterisks.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
**********************  
1=CLOSET  
2=CORRIDOR  
**********************  
1=BASEMENT  
2=BOILER RM  
3=CLASSROOM  
3=ELECTRIC RM  
Noun Screen #2  
Noun Screen #1  
**********************  
1=ELEVATOR  
2=ENTRANCE  
3=FLOOR  
**********************  
1=GARAGE  
2=HALLWAY  
3=HVAC RM  
Noun Screen #3  
Noun Screen #4  
**********************  
1=KITCHEN  
2=LOBBY  
**********************  
1=PATIENT  
2=RESTROOM  
3=ROOM  
3=OFFICE  
Noun Screen #5  
Noun Screen #6  
**********************  
1=STAIRWAY  
2=STOREROOM  
3=WING  
**********************  
1=ZONE  
Noun Screen #8  
Noun Screen #7  
76  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 3 or 4 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will display screens similar to the previ-  
ous Adjective and Noun Screens. The new screens will list custom Adjectives and Nouns which  
have been programmed into the control panel using the PS-Tools programming kit. These descrip-  
tors are selected as described in the previous sections.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
Description  
EDIT DETECTOR  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
The Description selection allows the programmer to enter additional information about the detector  
currently being programmed. This information will be displayed as part of the device label on the  
display. Pressing 2 while viewing Edit Detector Screen #5 will cause the following screen to be  
displayed:  
Edit Detector Screen #5  
DESCRIPTION 1D002  
NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
********************  
Adjective/Noun Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear at the first asterisk to the left. The programmer can enter additional  
descriptive information about the device being programmed. This information will appear on the  
display along with the standard device label information.  
A maximum of 20 characters (including spaces) can be entered. To enter alphanumeric characters  
from the keypad, repeatedly press the appropriate key until the desired character is displayed in the  
first position. For example, to enter the letter B, press the 2 (ABC) key three times to toggle  
through the characters 2, A, and B. Press the right arrow key to move the cursor one position to the  
right and repeat the process to enter the next character. To enter a space, press the * (QZ) key four  
times until a blank appears in the desired position. When all characters have been entered, press the  
Enter key to store the information. The display will return to the Edit Detector Screen #5, display-  
ing the new information at the bottom of the screen.  
Recall/Increment Function  
In addition, the user may use the Recall/Increment function at any time when the cursor is on the  
first letter of the Description, Adjective or Noun field as follows:  
If the zero key is pressed, a 0 is placed in the first letter position.  
If the zero key is then pressed a second time with no intervening key actions, the entire field is  
replaced with the field entered for the previous device programmed, and the cursor moves to  
the last character of the field (Recall function). The Recalled Adjective or Noun field may  
now be changed letter-by-letter.  
If the zero key is pressed again with no other intervening key actions and the last character in  
the field is a number 0-9, the number is incremented by one. If the last character is a letter, it  
changes to a 0. If the last character is 9 it goes to 0.  
The above increment function may be repeated with each press of the zero key.  
As an example, the user could quickly enter ‘FLR_3_ROOM_305’ as follows:  
1. The cursor is on the first letter of the Adjective field. Press the zero key twice to display  
FLR_3.  
2. With the cursor on the first letter of the Noun field, press the zero key twice to recall the  
display ROOM_304. The cursor automatically jumps from the first to the last letter of the  
Noun field.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
3. With the cursor on the last letter of the Noun field, press the zero key again to increment the  
room number to 305.  
4. Press the right arrow key to advance the zone field.  
5. Select a zone number from 00 to 99. Z00 (default zone) is the general alarm zone. Z01  
through Z99 may be selected to link software zones.  
Module Programming  
Pressing 2, while viewing Point Program Screen #2, will allow the programmer to add, delete or  
change the programming of an addressable module. The following screen will be displayed by the  
control panel:  
POINT PROGRAM  
SELECT TYPE  
1=DETECTOR  
2=MODULE  
Point Program Screen #2  
MODULES  
1=ADD  
2=DELETE  
3=EDIT  
Modules Screen  
Add Module  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Modules Screen will display the following screen which allows the  
programmer to add a new module address to programming:  
ADD MODULE  
ENTER MODULE#  
***  
Add Module Screen #1  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left. The programmer keys in  
the three digit module address, such as 005.  
When the last digit is keyed-in, the following screen will be displayed:  
ADD MODULE  
1=CONTROL  
2=MONITOR  
Add Module Screen #2  
78  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 1 for Control Module or 2 for Monitor Module will cause the following screen to be dis-  
played:  
ADD MODULE  
MODULE#  
IS ADDED  
005  
Add Module Screen #3  
The programmer can continue adding modules by pressing the ESC or left arrow key which will  
return the display to the Add Module Screen #1.  
Delete Module  
Pressing 2 in the Modules Screen will display the Delete Module Screen which allows the program-  
mer to delete a specific module:  
MODULES  
1=ADD  
2=DELETE  
3=EDIT  
DELETE MODULE  
ENTER MODULE#  
***  
Modules Screen  
Delete Module Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left. Using the panel keypad,  
key in the module address such as 005. When the last digit is keyed in, the following confirmation  
that the module has been deleted will be displayed:  
DELETE MODULE  
MODULE#  
IS DELETED  
005  
Edit Module Screen for Monitor Module  
The programmer can change a modules existing or factory default programming by pressing 3 in  
the Modules Screen. The following screen will be displayed:  
EDIT MODULE  
ENTER MODULE ADDRESS  
***  
Edit Module Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left. The programmer keys in  
the three digit module address, such as 012. When the last digit is keyed-in, if the selected address  
has not been added to programming, a screen showing information about a device that is installed  
with a lower address, closest to the selected address, will be displayed. If no modules are installed  
on the loop, the following screen will be displayed:  
NO MODULE  
INSTALLED  
Edit Module Screen  
If the selected address has been added to programming but a module (such as a monitor module)  
with the selected address is not physically installed on the SLC or has a communication fault, the  
following screen will be displayed:  
TROUBL MONITOR  
<ADJ><NOUN>  
ZNNN  
1M012  
If the selected address has been added to programming and a module (such as a monitor module)  
with the selected address is physically installed on the SLC and is communicating with the control  
panel, the following screen will be displayed:  
NORMAL MONITOR  
<ADJ><NOUN>  
ZNNN  
1M012  
To change the programming for the displayed module, press the keyboard down arrow key to view  
the following Edit Monitor screens. In the preceding example:  
• Normal - indicates that the module with the selected address is physically installed on the  
SLC and communicating with the control panel (enabled).  
• <ADJ><NOUN> - represents the adjective and noun, which have been programmed,  
describing the location of the displayed device.  
• ZNNN - represents the first of five possible software zones that the module is assigned to  
(NNN = the two digit zone number from 000 - 099).  
• 1M012 - represents the Loop, Device type and Device address (1 = SLC Loop 1, M=Module  
and 012 = Module Address 012).  
If the selected address corresponds to a control module, a screen displaying information about the  
control module with the selected address will be displayed as shown in “Edit Module Screen for  
Control Modules” on page 88.  
80  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
If the selected address corresponds to a monitor module, a screen displaying information about the  
module with the selected address will be displayed as illustrated in the following:  
NORMAL MONITOR  
<ADJ><NOUN>  
ZNNN  
1M012  
EDIT MONITOR 1M012  
1=ENABLED  
2=TYPE MONITOR  
YES  
Edit Monitor Screen #2  
EDIT MONITOR 1M012  
1=PRE-SIGNAL NO  
Edit Monitor Screen #3  
EDIT MONITOR 1M012  
1=WALKTEST  
YES  
2=ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
00 ** ** ** **  
Edit Monitor Screen #4  
EDIT MONITOR 1M012  
1=ADJECTIVE/NOUN  
2=DESCRIPTION  
********************  
Edit Monitor Screen #5  
Enable/Disable Module  
To Enable or Disable the monitor module, press the 1 key while viewing the Edit Module Screen  
#2. Each press of the key will toggle the screen between Enabled Yes and Enabled No. If Enabled  
No is selected, the module will not be polled by the control panel, preventing the module from  
reporting alarms and troubles to the panel. The control panel will indicate a system trouble condi-  
tion and the Disable LED with turn on if any devices are disabled.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Type Monitor  
EDIT MONITOR  
1=ENABLED  
The FACP response to the activation of a user-defined type is the same as most previous standard  
types in the list, thus allowing a variety of user-defined types and responses. To select the type of  
monitor module being programmed, press the 2 key while viewing the Edit Monitor Screen #2.  
This will cause the control panel to display the following Monitor Type Screens:  
2=TYPE MONITOR  
Edit Monitor Screen #2  
MONITOR TYPE  
1=PULL-STATION  
2=USER-DEFINED-1  
3=WATERFLOW  
Monitor Type Screen #1  
Pressing the down arrow key will display additional Monitor Type screens. While viewing one of  
the Monitor Type screens, select the type of monitor module being programmed by pressing the  
corresponding keypad number key. The display will return to the Edit Monitor Screen #2 which  
will show the new type selection.  
Table 3.1 lists the Monitor Types and their respective functions.  
82  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Master Programming Level  
Monitor module type selection will affect the function of the point as follows:  
Programming  
Monitor Type  
Action When Activated  
Fire Alarm  
Pull-Station  
User-Defined-1  
Waterflow  
same as previous (Pull-Station)  
Fire Alarm Delayed  
User-Defined-2  
Monitor  
same as previous (Waterflow)  
Fire Alarm  
User-Defined-3  
Future  
same as previous (Monitor)  
not used  
Future  
not used  
Smoke-Conventional1  
User-Defined-5  
Heat-Conventional  
User-Defined-6  
Medic-Alert2  
Fire Alarm  
same as previous (Smoke-Conventional)  
Fire Alarm  
same as previous (Heat-Detector)  
Supervisory, latching  
User-Defined-7  
Hazard-Alert2  
User-Defined-8  
Tornado-Alert2  
User-Defined-9  
Phone  
same as previous (Medic-Alert)  
Supervisory, latching  
same as previous (Hazard-Alert)  
Supervisory, latching  
same as previous (Tornado-Alert)  
Active Phone (LCD display only)  
same as previous (Phone)  
Supervisory, nonlatching (tracking)  
same as previous (Tamper)  
Supervisory, latching  
User-Defined-10  
Tamper  
User-Defined-11  
Supervisory  
User-Defined-12  
Supervisory-AR3  
User-Defined-13  
HVAC OVRRIDE4  
Power-Monitor  
User-Defined-14  
Trouble-Monitor  
User-Defined-15  
Process-Monitor2  
User-Defined 16  
Process-Monitor-AR2, 3  
User-Defined-17  
Future  
same as previous (Supervisory)  
Supervisory, nonlatching (tracking)  
same as previous (Supervisory-AR)  
Switch Supervisory, nonlatching (tracking)  
Power Fault  
same as previous (Power Monitor)  
Trouble  
same as previous (Trouble Monitor)  
Piezo  
same as previous (Process-Monitor)  
Piezo, nonlatching (tracking)  
same as previous (Process-Monitor-AR)  
not used  
Future  
not used  
Ack-Switch  
Acts like panel Acknowledge Key  
Acts like panel Silence Key  
Acts like panel Reset Key  
Acts like panel Drill Key  
PAS Disable  
Sil-Switch  
Reset-Switch  
Drill-Switch  
PAS-Bypass  
HVAC RESTART4  
Drill-Switch-AR3  
Switch  
Drill Switch, nonlatching (tracking)  
Table 3.1 Monitor Types  
1 Conventional 2-wire smoke detectors may be powered using an external power supply  
with an SLC Control Relay Module programmed for Resettable Power operation (refer  
to note 1 on page page 89).  
2 Combination systems employing these non-fire monitor types require the SLC loop to  
be programmed by the installer for Style 4 operation and isolator modules must be  
employed on each non-fire branch of the SLC as per Figure 13 in the Fire-Lite SLC  
Wiring Manual (document number 51309). Fire and non-fire devices must not be used  
on the same SLC branch.  
3 For all entries ending in AR, AR refers to AutoResettable.  
4 For HVAC RESTART and HVAC OVRRIDE descriptions, refer to “Monitor Module  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pre-signal  
EDIT MONITOR  
1=PRE-SIGNAL  
To enable the Pre-signal feature, press 1 while viewing Edit Monitor Screen #3 until the display  
reads Pre-signal Yes. Each press of the 1 key will cause the display to toggle between Pre-signal  
Yes and Pre-signal No. Refer to “Presignal” on page 158 for additional information.  
Edit Monitor Screen #3  
Walktest  
The Walktest feature allows one person to test the system devices without the necessity of manually  
resetting the control panel after each device activation. To enable devices, which are connected to  
a monitor module, for the Walktest feature, press 1 while viewing the Edit Monitor Screen #4 until  
the display reads Walktest Yes. Each press of the 1 key will cause the display to toggle between  
Walktest Yes and Walktest No. Refer to “Walktest” on page 160 for additional information.  
EDIT MONITOR  
1=WALKTEST  
2=ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
00 ** ** ** **  
Edit Monitor Screen #4  
Zone Assignment  
A maximum of five zones can be programmed to each addressable monitor module. Pressing 2  
while viewing Edit Monitor Screen #4 displays the following screen:  
MON ZONE ASSIGN  
Z00 Z** Z** Z** Z**  
Zone Assignment Screen  
Note that Z** represents the Zone Number(s) corresponding to this device. The factory default for  
an unprogrammed device is Z00 for general alarm zone. A flashing cursor will appear on the first 0  
to the left. Enter the two digit number corresponding to the zone that is to be assigned to this  
device. The cursor moves to the next Z** designation. Continue entering zone assignments or the  
remaining zones can be left blank or programmed as general alarm zones Z00. When all desired  
changes have been made, press the Enter key to store the zone assignments. The display will return  
to the Edit Monitor Screen #4.  
Noun/Adjective  
EDIT MONITOR  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
*****************  
The Noun/Adjective selection allows the programmer to enter specific descriptors about the moni-  
tor module currently being programmed. Pressing 1 while viewing Edit Monitor Screen #5 will  
cause the following screen to be displayed:  
Edit Monitor Screen #5  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
84  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will cause the following screen(s) to be dis-  
played. Note that the keyboard down arrow key must be pressed to see all the Adjective screens.  
Press the number corresponding to the adjective that is to be used as a descriptor for the location of  
the monitor module currently being programmed.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
**********************  
1=WEST  
2=FRONT  
**********************  
1=NORTH  
2=SOUTH  
3=EAST  
3=CENTER  
Adjective Screen #2  
Adjective Screen #1  
**********************  
1=MAIN  
2=FIRST  
**********************  
1=REAR  
2=UPPER  
3=2ND  
3=LOWER  
Adjective Screen #4  
Adjective Screen #3  
**********************  
1=3RD  
2=4TH  
**********************  
1=FLOOR 1  
2=FLOOR 2  
3=5TH  
3=FLOOR 3  
Adjective Screen #5  
Adjective Screen #6  
**********************  
1=FLOOR 4  
2=FLOOR 5  
3=ROOM  
Adjective Screen #7  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will cause the following screen(s) to be dis-  
played. Note that the keyboard down arrow key must be pressed to see all the Noun screens. Press  
the number corresponding to the noun that is to be used as a descriptor for the location of the mon-  
itor module currently being programmed.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
**********************  
1=CLOSET  
2=CORRIDOR  
**********************  
1=BASEMENT  
2=BOILER RM  
3=CLASSROOM  
3=ELECTRIC RM  
Noun Screen #2  
Noun Screen #1  
**********************  
1=GARAGE  
2=HALLWAY  
**********************  
1=ELEVATOR  
2=ENTRANCE  
3=FLOOR  
3=HVAC RM  
Noun Screen #4  
Noun Screen #3  
**********************  
1=KITCHEN  
2=LOBBY  
**********************  
1=PATIENT  
2=RESTROOM  
3=ROOM  
3=OFFICE  
Noun Screen #5  
Noun Screen #6  
**********************  
1=STAIRWAY  
2=STOREROOM  
3=WING  
**********************  
1=ZONE  
Noun Screen #8  
Noun Screen #7  
Pressing 3 or 4 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will display screens similar to the previ-  
ous Adjective and Noun Screens. The new screens will list Custom Adjectives and Nouns which  
have been programmed into the control panel using the PS-Tools programming kit.  
86  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Description  
Programming  
EDIT MONITOR  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
*****************  
The Description selection allows the programmer to enter additional information about the monitor  
module currently being programmed. This information will be displayed as part of the device label  
on the LCD display. Pressing 2 while viewing Edit Monitor Screen #5 will cause the following  
screen to be displayed:  
Edit Monitor Screen #5  
DESCRIPTION 1M012  
NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
********************  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear at the first asterisk to the left. The programmer can enter additional  
descriptive information about the device being programmed. This information will appear on the  
LCD display along with the standard device label information.  
A maximum of 20 characters (including spaces) can be entered. To enter alphanumeric characters  
from the keypad, repeatedly press the appropriate key until the desired character is displayed in the  
first position. For example, to enter the letter B, press the 2 (ABC) key three times to toggle  
through the characters 2, A, and B. Press the right arrow key to move the cursor one position to the  
right and repeat the process to enter the next character. To enter a space, press the * (QZ) key four  
times until a blank appears in the desired position. When all characters have been entered, press the  
Enter key to store the information. The display will return to the Edit Monitor Screen #4, display-  
ing the new information at the bottom of the screen.  
Recall/Increment Function  
In addition, the user may use the Recall/Increment function at any time when the cursor is on the  
first letter of the Adjective or Noun field as follows:  
If the zero key is pressed, a 0 is placed in the first letter position.  
If the zero key is then pressed a second time with no intervening key actions, the entire  
Adjective field is replaced with the field entered for the previous device programmed, and the  
cursor moves to the last character of the field (Recall function). The Recalled Adjective or  
Noun field may now be changed letter-by-letter.  
If the zero key is pressed again with no other intervening key actions and the last character in  
the field is a number 0-9, the number is incremented by one. If the last character is a letter, it  
changes to a 0. If the last character is 9 it goes to 0.  
The above increment function may be repeated with each press of the zero key.  
As an example, the user could quickly enter ‘FLR_3_ROOM 305’ as follows:  
1. The cursor is on the first letter of the Adjective field. Press the zero key twice to display  
FLR_3.  
2. With the cursor on the first letter of the Noun field, press the zero key twice to recall the  
display ROOM_304. The cursor automatically jumps from the first to the last letter of the  
Noun field.  
3. With the cursor on the last letter of the Noun field, press the zero key again to increment the  
room number to 305.  
4. Press the right arrow key to advance the zone field.  
5. Select a zone number from 00 to 99. Z00 (default zone) is the general alarm zone. Z01  
through Z99 may be selected to link software zones.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Edit Module Screen for Control Modules  
The programmer can change a module’s existing or factory default programming by pressing 3 in  
MODULES  
1=ADD  
the Modules Screen. The following screen will be displayed:  
2=DELETE  
3=EDIT  
EDIT MODULE  
ENTER MODULE ADDRESS  
***  
Modules Screen  
Edit Module Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear in the position of the first asterisk to the left.  
The programmer keys in the three digit module address, such as 002. When the last digit is keyed  
in, if the selected address corresponds to a control module, a screen displaying information about  
the control module with the selected address will be displayed as illustrated in the following:  
NORMAL  
CONTROL  
<ADJ><NOUN>  
SW ZNNN  
1M002  
Edit Control Screen #1  
In the preceding example:  
Normal - indicates that the module with the selected address is physically installed on the SLC  
and communicating with the control panel (enabled).  
<ADJ><NOUN> - represents the adjective and noun, which have been programmed,  
describing the location of the displayed device.  
Control - indicates that the selected module is a control module.  
S or * - represents Silenceable (S) or Nonsilenceable (*).  
W or * - represents Waterflow Timer Delay (W = Waterflow Timer Delay enabled, * =  
Waterflow Timer Delay disabled).  
ZNNN - represents the first of five possible software zones that the module is assigned to  
(NNN = the three digit zone number from 000 - 099).  
1M002 - represents the Loop, Device type and Device address (1 = SLC Loop 1, M=Module  
and 002 = Module Address 02).  
88  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
To change the programming for the displayed module, press the keyboard down arrow key to view  
the following Edit Control screens:  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=ENABLED  
YES  
2=TYPE CONTROL  
3=SILENCEABLE YES  
Edit Control Screen #2  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=WALKTEST  
YES  
2=ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
00 ** ** ** **  
Edit Control Screen #3  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
********************  
Edit Control Screen #4  
Enable/Disable Module  
To Enable or Disable the control module, press the 1 key while viewing the Edit Control Screen #2.  
Each press of the key will toggle the screen between Enabled Yes and Enabled No. If Enabled No  
is selected, the module will not be polled by the control panel, preventing the module from activat-  
ing its output devices. The control panel will indicate a system trouble condition and the Disable  
LED will turn on if any devices are disabled.  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=ENABLED  
2=TYPE  
3=SILENCEABLE  
Edit Control Screen #2  
Type  
To select the type of control module being programmed, press the 2 key while viewing the Edit  
Control Screen #2. This will cause the control panel to display the following Control Type Screens.  
Press the down arrow key to view additional screens and selections.  
CONTROL TYPE  
1=BLANK  
2=BELL-CIRCUIT  
3=HORN-CIRCUIT  
Control Type Screen #1  
While viewing one of the Control Type screens, select the type of control module being pro-  
grammed by pressing the corresponding keypad number key. The display will return to the Edit  
Control Screen #2 and indicate the new type selection.  
NOTE: A control relay module set to the Resettable Power type will follow the main circuit board  
24 VDC resettable power unless the control relay module is disabled.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
The following table contains control module type codes and their functions which are displayed in  
the Control Type screens:  
Control Type  
Bell Circuit  
Special Function  
NAC Type - supervised  
NAC Type - supervised  
NAC Type - supervised  
Ignore Open Circuit  
Horn Circuit  
Sounders  
Relay  
Strobe Circuit  
Control  
NAC Type - supervised  
NAC Type - supervised  
Relay Type - Ignore Open Circuit  
Relay Type - Ignore Open Circuit  
Resettable Power1  
HVAC SHUTDN 2  
1 When using a control relay module to supply resettable power to conventional 2-  
wire smoke detectors, the MMF-302 monitor module must be set for smoke-  
conventional operation.  
2 For HVAC SHUTDN description, refer to “Control Module Operation” on  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=ENABLED  
2=TYPE  
Silenceable  
3=SILENCEABLE  
The Silenceable selection allows the programmer to select whether output devices connected to the  
control module can be silenced, either by pressing the Alarm Silence key or by enabling Autosi-  
lence. Pressing the 3 key while viewing Edit Control Screen #2 will enable the Silenceable feature  
causing the display to read Silenceable Yes. Repeated presses of the 3 key will cause the display to  
toggle between Silenceable Yes and Silenceable No.  
Edit Control Screen #2  
Note that nonsilenceable outputs will not be activated for Fire Drill.  
Walktest  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=WALKTEST  
The Walktest feature allows one person to test the system devices without the necessity of manually  
resetting the control panel after each device activation. To enable devices, which are connected to  
a control module, for the Walktest feature, press 1 while viewing the Edit Control Screen #3 until  
the display reads Walktest Yes. Each press of the 1 key will cause the display to toggle between  
Walktest Yes and Walktest No. Refer to “Walktest” on page 160 for additional information.  
2=ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
00 ** ** ** **  
Edit Control Screen #3  
Zone Assignment  
A maximum of five zones can be programmed to each addressable control module. Pressing 2  
while viewing Edit Control Screen #3 displays the following screen:  
ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Z00 Z** Z** Z** Z**  
Zone Assignment Screen  
Note that Z** represents the Zone Number(s) corresponding to this device. The factory default for  
an unprogrammed device is Z00 for general alarm zone. A flashing cursor will appear on the first 0  
to the left. Enter the two digit number corresponding to the zone that is to be assigned to this  
device. The cursor moves to the next Z** designation. Continue entering zone assignments or the  
90  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
remaining zones can be left blank or programmed as general alarm zones Z00. When all desired  
changes have been made, press the Enter key to store the zone assignments. The display will return  
to the Edit Control Screen #3.  
Noun/Adjective  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
2=DESCRIPTION  
The Noun/Adjective selection allows the programmer to enter specific descriptors about the control  
module currently being programmed. Pressing 1 while viewing Edit Control Screen #4 will cause  
the following screen to be displayed:  
Edit Control Screen #4  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will cause the following screen(s) to be dis-  
played. Note that the keyboard down arrow key must be pressed to see all the Adjective screens.  
Press the number corresponding to the adjective that is to be used as a descriptor for the location of  
the control module currently being programmed.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
**********************  
1=WEST  
2=FRONT  
**********************  
1=NORTH  
2=SOUTH  
3=EAST  
3=CENTER  
Adjective Screen #2  
Adjective Screen #1  
**********************  
1=MAIN  
2=FIRST  
**********************  
1=REAR  
2=UPPER  
3=2ND  
3=LOWER  
Adjective Screen #4  
Adjective Screen #3  
**********************  
1=3RD  
2=4TH  
**********************  
1=FLOOR 1  
2=FLOOR 2  
3=5TH  
3=FLOOR 3  
Adjective Screen #5  
Adjective Screen #6  
**********************  
1=FLOOR 4  
2=FLOOR 5  
3=ROOM  
Adjective Screen #7  
92  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will cause the following screen(s) to be dis-  
played. Note that the keyboard down arrow key must be pressed to see all the Noun screens. Press  
the number corresponding to the noun that is to be used as a descriptor for the location of the con-  
trol module currently being programmed.  
1=STANDARD ADJECTIVE  
2=STANDARD NOUN  
3=CUSTOM ADJECTIVE  
4=CUSTOM NOUN  
Noun/Adjective Screen  
**********************  
1=CLOSET  
2=CORRIDOR  
**********************  
1=BASEMENT  
2=BOILER RM  
3=CLASSROOM  
3=ELECTRIC RM  
Noun Screen #2  
Noun Screen #1  
**********************  
1=GARAGE  
2=HALLWAY  
**********************  
1=ELEVATOR  
2=ENTRANCE  
3=FLOOR  
3=HVAC RM  
Noun Screen #4  
Noun Screen #3  
**********************  
1=KITCHEN  
2=LOBBY  
**********************  
1=PATIENT  
2=RESTROOM  
3=ROOM  
3=OFFICE  
Noun Screen #5  
Noun Screen #6  
**********************  
1=STAIRWAY  
2=STOREROOM  
3=WING  
**********************  
1=ZONE  
Noun Screen #8  
Noun Screen #7  
Pressing 3 or 4 while viewing the Noun/Adjective Screen will display screens similar to the previ-  
ous Adjective and Noun Screens. The new screens will list Custom Adjectives and Nouns which  
have been programmed into the control panel using the PS-Tools programming kit.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Description  
EDIT CONTROL  
1=ADJECTIVE/NOUN  
2=DESCRIPTION  
The Description selection allows the programmer to enter additional information about the control  
module currently being programmed. This information will be displayed as part of the device label  
on the display. Pressing 2 while viewing Edit Control Screen #4 will cause the following screen to  
be displayed:  
Edit Control Screen #4  
DESCRIPTION 1M002  
NOUN/ADJECTIVE  
********************  
Adjective/Noun Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear at the first asterisk to the left. The programmer can enter additional  
descriptive information about the device being programmed. This information will appear on the  
display along with the standard device label information.  
A maximum of 20 characters (including spaces) can be entered. To enter alphanumeric characters  
from the keypad, repeatedly press the appropriate key until the desired character is displayed in the  
first position. For example, to enter the letter B, press the 2 (ABC) key three times to toggle  
through the characters 1, A, and B. Press the right arrow key to move the cursor one position to the  
right and repeat the process to enter the next character. To enter a space, press the * (QZ) key four  
times until a blank appears in the desired position. When all characters have been entered, press the  
Enter key to store the information. The display will return to the Edit Control Screen #4, displaying  
the new information at the bottom of the screen.  
Recall/Increment Function  
In addition, the user may use the Recall/Increment function at any time when the cursor is on the  
first letter of the Adjective or Noun field as follows:  
If the zero key is pressed, a 0 is placed in the first letter position.  
If the zero key is then pressed a second time with no intervening key actions, the entire  
Adjective field is replaced with the field entered for the previous device programmed, and the  
cursor moves to the last character of the field (Recall function). The Recalled Adjective or  
Noun field may now be changed letter-by-letter.  
If the zero key is pressed again with no other intervening key actions and the last character in  
the field is a number 0-9, the number is incremented by one. If the last character is a letter, it  
changes to a 0. If the last character is 9 it goes to 0.  
The above increment function may be repeated with each press of the zero key.  
As an example, the user could quickly enter ‘FLR_3_ROOM 305’ as follows:  
1. The cursor is on the first letter of the Adjective field. Press the zero key twice to display  
FLR_3.  
2. With the cursor on the first letter of the Noun field, press the zero key twice to recall the  
display ROOM_304. The cursor automatically jumps from the first to the last letter of the  
Noun field.  
3. With the cursor on the last letter of the Noun field, press the zero key again to increment the  
room number to 305.  
4. Press the right arrow key to advance the zone field.  
5. Select a zone number from 00 to 99. Z00 (default zone) is the general alarm zone. Z01  
through Z99 may be selected to link software zones.  
94  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
3.6.3 Zone Setup  
Pressing 3 while viewing Programming Screen #1 will access the Zone Setup screens as illustrated  
below:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=AUTOPROGRAM  
2=POINT PROGRAM  
3=ZONE SETUP  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ENABLE  
2=DISABLE  
Programming Screen #2  
3=ZONE 97 98 99  
Zone Setup Screen #1  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONES INSTALLED  
2=ZONES ENABLED  
3=ZONES DISABLED  
Zone Setup Screen #2  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONE TYPES  
2=ZONES AVAILABLE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Zone Setup Screen #3  
Enable  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ENABLE  
Pressing 1 for Enable, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #1, will display the following screen:  
2=DISABLE  
3=ZONE 97 98 99  
Zone Setup Screen #1  
ZONE TO ENABLE  
Z
Enable Screen  
This screens allows the programmer to enable zones, one at a time. A flashing cursor appears next  
to the Z, prompting the programmer to enter a two digit zone number (01 - 99). When the second  
digit is entered, the zone will be enabled and the cursor returns to the original position next to the Z.  
Another zone can then be enabled.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Disable  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ENABLE  
Pressing 2 for Disable, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #1, will display the following screen:  
2=DISABLE  
3=ZONE 97 98 99  
Zone Setup Screen #1  
ZONE TO DISABLE  
Z
Disable Screen  
This screen allows the programmer to disable zones, one at a time. A flashing cursor appears next  
to the Z, prompting the programmer to enter a two digit zone number (01 - 99). When the second  
digit is entered, the zone will be disabled and the cursor will return to the original position next to  
the Z. Another zone can then be disabled.  
Zone 97, 98 and 99  
Pressing 3 for Zone 97, 98 and 99, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #1, will display the following  
screen:  
SPEC PURPOSE ZONE  
1=PAS 97  
OFF  
2=PRESIGNAL 98 OFF  
3=TWO STAGE 99 OFF  
Zone 97, 98 and 99 Screen  
Zones 97, 98 and 99 can be programmed for normal zone operation or for special purpose applica-  
tions. In the above illustration, the three zones are shown Off, which means they can be pro-  
grammed to function in the same manner as all other zones, by assigning them to input and output  
devices in the Programming Zone Assignment Screen.  
Pressing 1 will cause the display to change to PAS 97 On. Each press of the 1 key will cause the  
display to toggle between PAS 97 On and PAS 97 Off. When Zone 97 is programmed On, a PAS  
(Positive Alarm Sequence) activation of any detector will cause Zone 97 to activate. By assigning  
Zone 97 to a control module in the Programming Zone Assignment Screen, an output device con-  
nected to the control module can be used to indicate a PAS condition in the control panel. Do not  
assign Zone 97 to a Notification Appliance Circuit when using this zone to indicate a PAS condi-  
tion.  
Pressing 2 will cause the display to change to Pre-signal 98 On. Each press of the 2 key will cause  
the display to toggle between Pre-signal 98 On and Pre-signal 98 Off. When Zone 98 is pro-  
grammed On, a Pre-signal activation of any device will cause Zone 98 to activate. By assigning  
Zone 98 to a control module in the Programming Zone Assignment Screen, an output device con-  
nected to the control module can be used to indicate a Pre-signal condition in the control panel. Do  
not assign Zone 98 to a Notification Appliance Circuit when using this zone to indicate a Pre-signal  
condition.  
Pressing 3 will cause the display to change to Two Stage 99 On. Each press of the 3 key will cause  
the display to toggle between Two Stage 99 On and Two Stage 99 Off. Refer to “Two Stage Opera-  
tion” on page 111 for a description of this feature.  
96  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Zones Installed  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONES INSTALLED  
2=ZONES ENABLED  
3=ZONES DISABLED  
Pressing 1 for Zones Installed, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #2, will display a screen similar to  
the following:  
Zone Setup Screen #2  
ZONES INSTALLED  
00 01 02 03 04 05  
Zones Installed Screen  
This display will show all of the zones that have been programmed into the control panel. Note that  
an up and/or down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that addi-  
tional screens of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view the additional  
zones.  
Zones Enabled  
Pressing 2 for Zones Enabled, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #2, will display a screen similar to  
the following:  
ZONES ENABLED  
00 01 02 04 05 06 07  
08 09 10 11 12 13 14  
15 16 17 18 19 20 21  
Zones Enabled Screen  
This display will show all of the zones that are enabled in the control panel. Note that an up and/or  
down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that additional screens  
of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view the additional zones.  
Zones Disabled  
Pressing 3 for Zones Disabled, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #2, will display a screen similar  
to the following:  
ZONES DISABLED  
03  
Zones Disabled Screen  
This display will show all of the zones that are disabled in the control panel. Note that an up and/or  
down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that additional screens  
of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view the additional zones.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Zone Type  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONE TYPES  
2=ZONES AVAILABLE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Zone Types must be programmed only if a DACT, programmed for zone reporting, is installed on  
the control panel. Pressing 1 for Zone Types, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #3, will display a  
screen similar to the following:  
Zone Setup Screen #3  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=Z00 MONITOR  
2=Z01 MONITOR  
3=Z02 MONITOR  
Zones Installed Screen  
This display will show the system zones (default and user programmed) and their associated types.  
Note that an up and/or down arrow will appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating  
that additional screens of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view zones  
Z00 through Z99.  
Zone types can be changed by pressing the keypad number key corresponding to the zone in each  
Zones Installed Screen. Available zone types will be displayed in the resultant screens. For exam-  
ple, to change the zone type for zone Z02 in the screen illustrated above, press 3. The following  
screens will be displayed:  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=MONITOR  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=HEAT  
2=SMOKE PHOTO  
3=WATERFLOW  
2=PULL STATION  
3=DUCT  
Zone Type Program Screen #1  
Zone Type Program Screen #2  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=MEDICAL  
2=HAZARD  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=SUPERVISORY  
2=PROC. MON  
3=TAMPER  
3=SMOKE ION  
Zone Type Program Screen #4  
Zone Type Program Screen #3  
To change the zone type for Z02 to Pull Station, scroll the display until Zone Type Program Screen  
#2 is displayed. Press 2 to program zone Z02 as a Pull Station zone. The display will return to the  
Zones Installed Screen showing zone Z02 and the Pull Station program type. Repeat the procedure  
for each zone to be changed.  
IMPORTANT! In Zone Type Program Screen #1, selecting WATERFLOW will assign a Water-  
flow silenceable zone type to the selected zone. Any signaling devices programmed to the same  
zone can be silenced by pressing the Alarm Silence key or by using the auto-silence feature.  
To program a waterflow circuit as nonsilenceable, refer to “System Setup” on page 100.  
NOTE: Zone Types are only relevant for Central Station reporting. Changing a zone type will only  
change how it is reported to the Central Station.  
98  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Zones Available  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONE TYPES  
Pressing 2 while viewing Zone Setup Screen #3 will display the following screen:  
2=ZONES AVAILABLE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Zone Setup Screen #3  
ZONES AVAILABLE  
01 02 03 04 05 06 07  
08 09 10 11 12 13 14  
15 16 17 18 19  
The display will show all of the zones that are still available for programming. Note that an up  
and/or down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that additional  
screens of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow key to view additional screens.  
3.6.4 Loop Setup  
Loop Setup allows the programmer to configure the SLC Loop(s) for NFPA Style 4, 6 or 7 wiring  
and to select the protocol for each loop. Pressing 1 while viewing Programming Screen #2 will  
cause the following screen to be displayed:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=LOOP SETUP  
2=SYSTEM SETUP  
3=VERIFY LOOPS  
LOOP SETUP  
1=LOOP 1  
2=LOOP 2  
Programming Screen #2  
3-PROTOCOL CLIP  
Loop Selection Screen  
Loop Selection  
Press 1 while viewing the Loop Selection Screen to configure Loop1 or 2 to configure Loop 2. The  
following screens will appear for each loop.  
LOOP # SETUP  
1=STYLE  
4
Loop Setup Screen  
Style  
To program the SLC Style for the selected loop, press 1 for Style, while viewing Loop Setup  
Screen. In the preceding example, the control panel is programmed for Style 4 SLC wiring as indi-  
cated by the 4 to the right of Style in the display. To change the wiring style, press 1 to toggle the  
display to read Style 6. Each press of the 1 key will cause the display to toggle between Style 4 and  
Style 6. Note that, when programming the Loop Style, the programmer can only select between  
Style 4 and Style 6. To program a system for Style 7 wiring, the programmer must select the Loop  
Setup for Style 6. Style 7 wiring is the same as Style 6 with the added requirement that each  
addressable device on the loop must have a pair of isolator modules, one on each side.  
Note on SLC Troubles: If the FACP reports an open fault on an SLC Loop programmed for Style  
6, the trouble condition will latch at the FACP. When the SLC Loop has been repaired, the Reset  
button must be pressed at the FACP (at least 2 minutes after the trouble has been repaired) to clear  
the SLC trouble.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Loop Protocol  
Loop Protocol refers to the SLC loop mode of operation. Refer to “Wire Requirements” on  
page 196 for wire specifications based upon SLC protocol. Two modes of operation are available:  
LiteSpeed and CLIP mode. CLIP mode (Classic Loop Interface Protocol) is used for the older leg-  
acy addressable devices such as the M300 Series modules and detectors. LiteSpeed mode is used  
for newer addressable devices such as the 350 series (or newer) for quicker response times. Note  
that the legacy devices can operate only in CLIP mode while the newer devices are compatible with  
both modes of operation. Pressing 3 while viewing the Loop Setup Screen will allow the program-  
mer to select between CLIP and LiteSpeed mode. Each press of the 3 key will toggle the setting  
between CLIP and LiteSpeed mode.  
Device Addressing  
It is important to note that the FACP addressable device capacity is 159 detectors and 159 con-  
trol/monitor modules per SLC loop. Since older legacy addressable devices cannot be set to  
addresses above 099, the newer series devices must be used when addresses 100 to 159 are to be  
installed. It is permissible to mix old and new devices in the same panel, however, the FACP must  
be programmed for CLIP mode.  
3.6.5 System Setup  
System Setup allows the programmer to configure the following control panel features:  
Trouble Reminder: This feature, when enabled, provides an audible reminder that an alarm or  
trouble still exists on the FACP after the control panel has been silenced. The control panel  
piezo sounder will pulse once every 15 seconds during an alarm and every two minutes during  
a trouble condition, after the Alarm Silence or Acknowledge key is pressed. The piezo will  
continue to sound at these rates until the alarm or trouble condition is cleared. If the trouble  
condition is not cleared within 24 hours, the panel will reactivate the trouble sounder and  
retransmit the trouble condition to the central station if connected.  
Banner: This option allows the user to change the top line of the LCD display from the blank  
factory default readout to a user defined readout when the control panel is in Normal condition.  
Time-Date: This feature allows the programmer to set the time, display format (24 hr or 12 hr),  
date and daylight savings time feature into the FACP memory  
Timers: This option allows the programmer to set the PAS (Positive Alarm Sequence) time  
delay, Pre-Signal time delay and Waterflow time delay.  
NACs: This feature allows the programmer to configure the control panel Notification  
Appliance Circuits for a variety of options, such as circuit type, silenceable/nonsilenceable,  
autosilence, coding, silence inhibit, zone assignment and enable/disable.  
Relays: This option allows programming of two onboard relays for activation by various  
control panel events, such as alarm, trouble, supervisory, etc.  
Canadian Option: This option allows the automatic programming of the FACP to Canadian  
Important! For Canadian Applications, this option must be set to ON prior to any other panel  
programming.  
Waterflow Silenceable: This option provides the ability to silence any output circuit activated  
by a monitor module programmed as a waterflow type.  
100  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                 
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 2 for System Setup, while viewing Programming Screen #2, will cause the following  
screens to be displayed:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=LOOP SETUP  
2=SYSTEM SETUP  
3=VERIFY LOOPS  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=TROUBLE REM OFF  
2=BANNER  
Programming Screen #2  
3=TIME-DATE  
System Setup Screen #1  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=TIMERS  
2=NAC  
3=RELAYS  
System Setup Screen #2  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=CANADIAN OPT. OFF  
2=WATERFLOW SIL. NO  
System Setup Screen #3  
Trouble Reminder  
The Trouble Reminder features causes the control panel piezo to sound a reminder ‘beep’ for  
alarms and troubles, after the panel has been silenced. Refer to “System Setup” on page 100, for a  
detailed description of this feature. Pressing 1 while viewing System Setup Screen #1 will cause  
the display to toggle to Trouble Rem On, which enables this feature. Each press of the 1 key will  
cause the display to toggle between Trouble Rem On and Trouble Rem Off.  
Banner  
The top line of the display, which appears when the control panel is in normal mode, can be  
changed by using the Banner option. Pressing 2 while viewing System Setup Screen #1 will cause  
the following to be displayed:  
BANNER  
1=FACTORY  
2=USER DEFINED  
Banner Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Banner Screen will select the blank factory default banner setting and  
display the following screen:  
BANNER  
1=FACTORY  
2=USER DEFINED  
Banner Screen  
FACTORY BANNER  
Factory Banner Screen  
Pressing the Enter key will store this selection in nonvolatile memory and return the display to the  
Banner Screen.  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Banner Screen will display the following screens :  
USER DEFINED BANNER  
PRESS ENTER IF OK  
User Defined Banner Screen #1  
USER BANNER - LINE 2  
PRESS ENTER IF OK  
************  
User Defined Banner Screen #2  
These screens allow the programmer to enter a two line custom banner. A flashing cursor will  
appear in the bottom left corner of each display. A maximum of 20 characters (including spaces)  
can be entered into each screen for a total of two lines with 40 characters. After entering up to 20  
characters in the first screen, press Enter to view the second screen. Enter up to 20 characters in the  
second screen in the same manner or just press Enter if a second banner line is not being entered.  
To quickly clear the current banner, press the CLR key.  
To enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad, repeatedly press the appropriate key until the  
desired character is displayed in the first position. For example, to enter the letter B, press the 2  
(ABC) key three times to toggle through the characters 1, A, and B. Press the right arrow key to  
move the cursor one position to the right and repeat the process to enter the next character. To enter  
a space, press the * (QZ) key four times to place a blank in the desired position. When all charac-  
ters have been entered, press Enter to store the information and return to the Banner Screen.  
102  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Time-Date  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=TROUBLE REM  
2=BANNER  
The control panel time and date can be changed by pressing 3 while viewing the System Setup  
3=TIME-DATE  
Screen #1. The following screen will be displayed:  
System Setup Screen #1  
TIME AND DATE  
1=TIME 10:00 AM  
2=DATE 02-04-2010  
3=CLOCK FORMAT 12HR  
Time-Date Screen #1  
TIME AND DATE  
1=DAYLIGHT SAVINGS  
Time-Date Screen #2  
Time  
To change the time, press 1 while viewing the Time-Date Screen. The following screen will be dis-  
played:  
ENTER TIME  
10:00 AM  
1=AM  
2=PM  
Time Screen  
A flashing cursor is located toward the top left of the display. Below the cursor is the current time.  
To change the time, enter the two-digit hours followed by the two-digit minutes. The cursor will  
move one position to the right each time a digit is entered. After the last minutes digit is entered,  
the cursor will again move one position to the right. At this point enter 1 for AM or 2 for PM. The  
display will then return to the Time-Date Screen which will show the new time entry. If an error is  
made while entering a digit, press the CLR key to delete the entire entry and beginning again.  
Date  
To change the date, press 2 while viewing the Time-Date Screen. The following screen will be dis-  
played:  
ENTER DATE  
MONTH DAY YEAR  
02-04-2010  
Date Screen  
A flashing cursor is located toward the top left of the display. Below the cursor is the current date.  
To change the date, enter the two-digit month followed by the two-digit day and then the two-digit  
year (09 for 2009, 10 for 2010, etc.). The cursor will move one position to the right each time a  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
digit is entered. After the last year digit is entered, the display will return to the Time-Date Screen  
which will show the new date entry. If an error is made while entering a digit, press the CLR key to  
delete the entire entry and beginning again.  
Clock Format  
The clock can be configured to display 12 hour (AM & PM) or 24 hour (military) time. Pressing 3  
while viewing the Time-Date screen will cause the display to toggle between 12HR and 24HR.  
Select 12HR for 12 hour display or 24HR for 24 hour display.  
NOTE: If the clock is changed to 24 hour (military) format, the date will change to the European  
standard of Day-Month-Year (for display purposes only).  
Daylight Savings Time  
TIME AND DATE  
1=DAYLIGHT SAVINGS  
Pressing 1 while viewing Time-Date Screen #2 will cause the following screens to be displayed:  
Time & Date Screen #2  
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS  
1=ENABLED  
YES  
2=START MONTH MAR  
3=START WEEK WEEK-2  
Daylight Savings Screen #1  
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS  
1=END MONTH NOV  
2=END WEEK WEEK-1  
Daylight Savings Screen #2  
Pressing 1 while viewing Daylight Savings Screen #1 will cause the display to toggle between  
Enabled Yes and Enabled No. The control panel will automatically update the time for daylight  
savings time when Enabled Yes is selected.  
Pressing 2 while viewing Daylight Savings Screen #1 will display another screen which allows the  
programmer to select the month that daylight savings time will begin. In this sub-screen, pressing  
1 will select March, 2 will select April, and 3 will select May.  
Pressing 3 while viewing Daylight Savings Screen #1 will display two sub-screens which allow the  
programmer to select the week of the month that daylight savings time will begin. In the first sub-  
screen, pressing 1 will select the first week, 2 will select the second week, and 3 will select the third  
week, while in the second sub-screen, pressing 1 will select the fourth week and 2 will select the  
last week of the selected month.  
Pressing 1 while viewing Daylight Savings Screen #2 will display another screen which allows the  
programmer to select the month that daylight savings time will end. In this sub-screen, pressing 1  
will select September, 2 will select October, and 3 will select November.  
Pressing 2 while viewing Daylight Savings Screen #2 will display two sub-screens which allow the  
programmer to select the week of the month that daylight savings time will end. In the first sub-  
screen, pressing 1 will select the first week, 2 will select the second week, and 3 will select the third  
week, while in the second sub-screen, pressing 4 will select the fourth week and 5 will select the  
last week of the selected month.  
104  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Timers  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=TIMERS  
2=NAC  
Timer delays for PAS, Pre-signal and waterflow activation can be programmed by pressing 1 while  
3=RELAYS  
viewing System Setup Screen #2. The following screen will be displayed:  
System Setup Screen #2  
TIMERS  
1=PAS DELAY  
2=PRE SIGNAL  
3=WATERFLOW  
000  
000  
000  
Timer Screen #1  
TIMERS  
1=AC LOSS DELAY 000  
Timer Screen #2  
PAS (Positive Alarm Sequence) Delay  
TIMERS  
1=PAS DELAY  
000  
The factory default setting for PAS is 000 for no delay. To select a PAS delay of 001 to 180 seconds  
for all devices programmed for PAS, press 1 while viewing Timer Screen #1. The following dis-  
play will appear:  
2=PRE SIGNAL 000  
3=WATERFLOW  
000  
Timer Screen #1  
PAS DELAY  
RANGE 0-180 SECONDS  
PAS Delay Screen  
A flashing cursor is positioned in the lower left corner of the display. Enter a delay time consisting  
of three digits, such as 005 for five seconds. Upon entering the third digit, the time delay will be  
stored in the control panel memory and the display will return to the Delay Screen which will indi-  
cate the new delay time.  
Pre-signal Delay  
The factory default setting for Pre-signal delay is 000 for no delay. To select a Pre-signal delay of  
001 to 180 seconds for all devices programmed for Pre-signal, press 2 while viewing Timer Screen  
#1. The following screen will be displayed:  
PRESIGNAL DELAY  
RANGE 0-180 SECONDS  
Pre-signal Delay Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
A flashing cursor is positioned in the lower left corner of the display. Enter a delay time consisting  
of three digits, such as 009 for nine seconds. Upon entering the third digit, the time delay will be  
stored in the control panel memory and the display will return to the Delay Screen which will indi-  
cate the new delay time.  
Note that the FACP can be programmed for either PAS or Pre-signal operation, not both. Refer to  
“Edit Detector” on page 69 for programming details.  
Waterflow Delay  
TIMER  
1=PAS DELAY  
2=PRE SIGNAL 000  
000  
A delay can be added prior to declaring a waterflow type of alarm. Be careful to include any built-  
in delays of the waterflow device. The factory default setting for Waterflow delay is 000 for no  
delay. To select a Waterflow delay of 01 to 90 seconds for all devices programmed for Waterflow  
delay, press 3 while viewing Timer Screen #1. The following screen will be displayed:  
3=WATERFLOW  
000  
Timer Screen #1  
WATERFLOW DELAY  
RANGE 0-90 SECONDS  
Waterflow Delay Screen  
A flashing cursor is positioned in the lower left corner of the display. Enter a delay time consisting  
of two digits, such as 25 for twenty-five seconds. Upon entering the second digit, the time delay  
will be stored in the control panel memory and the display will return to the Delay Screen which  
will indicate the new delay time.  
AC Loss Delay  
TIMER  
1=AC LOSS DELAY  
The reporting of a loss of AC power to a central station can be delayed by programming the length  
of the desired delay. The factory default setting is 2 hours. Press 1 while viewing Timer Screen #2  
to display the following:  
Timer Screen #2  
AC LOSS DELAY  
1=NO DELAY  
2=ENTER DELAY  
AC Loss Delay Screen #1  
Pressing 1 while viewing AC Loss Delay Screen #1 will program the FACP to transmit an AC Loss  
report immediately to the central station.  
106  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 2 while viewing AC Loss Delay Screen #1 will display the following screen:  
Programming  
AC LOSS DELAY  
RANGE 00-23  
AC Loss Delay Screen #2  
A flashing cursor will appear in the lower left corner of the display. The factory default setting is  
02 hours. Type the two digit AC loss reporting delay in hours (00 to 23 hour delay). When the sec-  
ond digit is entered, the display will return to AC Loss Delay Screen #1.  
NAC (Notification Appliance Circuit)  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=TIMERS  
2=NAC  
The options for the NACs on the control panel main circuit board can be set by pressing 2 while  
3=RELAYS  
viewing System Setup Screen #2. The following screens will be displayed:  
System Setup Screen #2  
NACS  
1=NAC 1  
2=NAC 2  
3=NAC 3  
4=NAC 4  
NAC Selection Screen  
The Notification Appliance Circuits can be configured independently by pressing 1 for NAC 1, 2  
for NAC 2, 3 for NAC 3, or 4 for NAC 4.  
Note that 3=NAC 3 and 4=NAC 4 will only be displayed if the NACKEY NAC option card is  
installed, in JP8 of the main circuit board, for Class B operation.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
The following screens will be displayed for either selection:  
NAC #  
1=ENABLED  
2=TYPE  
YES  
BELL  
3=SILENCEABLE YES  
NAC Screen #1  
NAC #  
1=AUTO SILENCE 00  
2=CODING  
TEMPORAL  
NAC Screen #2  
NAC #  
1=ZONE  
00 00 00 00 00  
2=SIL INHIBITED NO  
NAC Screen #3  
NAC #  
1=SYNC TYPE  
S
NAC Screen #4  
Enabled  
Pressing 1 while viewing NAC Screen #1 will cause the display to change to Enabled No. This will  
prevent the selected main circuit board NAC from activating its devices. Each press of the 1 key  
will cause the display to toggle between Enabled Yes and Enabled No.  
108  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Type  
NAC #  
1=ENABLED  
2=TYPE  
The main circuit board NAC type can be programmed by pressing 2 while viewing NAC Screen #1.  
The following screen will be displayed. Press the down arrow key to view additional screens:  
3=SILENCEABLE  
NAC Screen #1  
NAC TYPE  
1=BELL  
2=HORN  
3=STROBE  
Type Screen #1  
Select the NAC device type by pressing the number corresponding to the type in the appropriate  
screen. When the selection is made, the display will return to NAC Screen #1.  
The following table contains NAC type codes and their functions:  
NAC Type Code  
Bell  
Special Function  
None  
Horn  
None  
Strobe  
None  
Synced Strobe  
Strobe Sil Sync  
Future Use  
Future Use  
Future Use  
Blank  
Synchronized to manufacturer  
Same as Synced Strobe but Silence turns off audible & visual devices  
None  
None  
None  
None  
Silenceable  
Pressing 3 while viewing NAC Screen #1 will cause the display to change to Silenceable No. This  
will prevent the selected main circuit board NAC from being silenced by pressing the Alarm  
Silence key or by the Auto Silence feature. Each press of the 3 key will cause the display to toggle  
between Silenceable Yes and Silenceable No.  
Important: When a Notification Appliance Circuit with a mix of audible and visual devices is  
programmed for silenceable and the Synced Strobe feature is selected, only the audible devices  
will be turned off if the Silence key is pressed. The visual devices (strobes, etc.) will continue to  
operate. If the Strobe Sil Sync feature is selected, Silence will turn off both audible and visual  
devices.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Auto Silence  
NAC #  
1=AUTO SILENCE  
2=CODING  
The Auto Silence feature, when enabled, automatically silences all main circuit board silenceable  
notification appliances after a programmed length of time. To enable this feature and program the  
time delay before Auto Silence activation, press 1 while viewing NAC Screen #2. The following  
screens will be displayed:  
TEMPORAL  
NAC Screen #2  
AUTO SILENCE  
1=NO  
2=5 MINUTES  
3=10 MINUTES  
Auto Silence Screen #1  
AUTO SILENCE  
1=15 MINUTES  
2=20 MINUTES  
3=25 MINUTES  
Auto Silence Screen #2  
AUTO SILENCE  
1=30 MINUTES  
Auto Silence Screen #3  
To disable the Auto Silence feature, press 1 for No while viewing Auto Silence Screen #1. To  
enable the Auto Silence feature, press the number corresponding to the time delay which will  
elapse before Auto Silence activates. When a time delay is selected, the information will be stored  
in memory and the display will return to NAC Screen #2.  
Coding  
The Coding feature allows the programmer to select the type of output that the main circuit board  
notification appliances will generate when activated. Pressing 2 while viewing NAC Screen #2  
will cause the following displays to appear:  
CODING  
1=STEADY  
2=MARCH TIME  
3=CALIFORNIA  
Coding Screen #1  
CODING  
1=TEMPORAL  
2=TWO STAGE 3 MIN  
3=TWO STAGE 5 MIN  
Coding Screen #2  
110  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
The programmer can select the notification appliance output by pressing the number corresponding  
to the desired output. The coding selections are:  
Steady - a continuous output with no coding  
March Time - 120 ppm (pulse-per-minute) output  
California - 10 seconds on and 5 seconds off  
Temporal - ½ second on, ½ second off, ½ second on, ½ second off, ½ second on, 1½ second off  
Two Stage - refer to “Two Stage Operation” on page 111 for description  
Selection of one of the above options will cause the control panel to store the information in mem-  
ory and return the display to NAC Screen #2, which will display the new coding choice.  
Two Stage Operation  
Two Stage operation consists of the following:  
1st stage output - 20 ppm (pulse-per-minute) coding  
2nd stage output - Temporal coding as described above  
If Two Stage operation is programmed as the Coding option, the following sequence of events will  
occur during an alarm.  
1. The on-board NACs which are programmed to General Alarm Zone 0 will activate with a 1st  
stage output upon activation of any alarm point.  
2. If the activated alarm point is directly mapped to a zone which is programmed to an on-board  
NAC, that NAC will go directly to 2nd stage coding output. All other NACs not directly  
mapped to the activated alarm point’s zone but assigned to Zone 0 will activate with a 1st stage  
output.  
3. If, after the programmed time of 3 or 5 minutes, the Acknowledge switch has not been pressed,  
all NACs presently in 1st stage activation will go to 2nd stage activation.  
4. If an Acknowledge switch has been pressed, any NACs currently in 1st stage activation will  
remain in 1st stage. Pressing the Acknowledge switch does not affect NACs already in 2nd  
stage activation.  
5. If another alarm point is activated and the countdown timer is counting, the alarm point will  
have no effect on the NACs unless the alarm point’s zones are directly mapped to one of the  
NACs, in which case it will follow the procedure outlined in step 2.  
6. If another alarm point is activated and the countdown timer has stopped counting due to the  
Acknowledge switch being pressed, the countdown timer will restart and the NACs will  
respond as outlined in step 2. NACs already in 2nd stage activation will not be affected.  
7. Any control modules assigned to special Zone 99 will be activated either by direct mapping of  
an input device programmed to Zone 99 or if the timer counts down to zero and the NAC goes  
into 2nd stage coding.  
8. Control modules that are programmed to the same zone as the activated input device will not  
be delayed for activation.  
Zone  
NAC #  
1=ZONE  
A maximum of five zones can be programmed to each main circuit board NAC. Pressing 1 while  
viewing NAC Screen #3 displays the following screen:  
00 00 00 00 00  
2=SIL INHIBITED NO  
NAC Screen #3  
ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Z00 Z** Z** Z** Z**  
Zone Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Note that Z** represents the Zone Number(s) corresponding to the selected NAC. The factory  
default for an unprogrammed device is Z00 for general alarm zone. A flashing cursor will appear  
on the first 0 to the left. Enter the two digit number corresponding to the zone that is to be assigned  
to this NAC. The cursor moves to the next Z** designation. Continue entering zone assignments  
or the remaining zones can be left blank or programmed as general alarm zone Z00. When all  
desired changes have been made, press the Enter key to store the zone assignments. The display  
will return to the NAC Screen #3 which will show the zone assignments just entered.  
Silence Inhibited  
The Silence Inhibit feature, when enabled, prevents the silencing of the selected main circuit board  
NAC for a period of one minute. Pressing 2 while viewing NAC Screen #3 will cause the display  
to change from the factory default of Silence Inhibit No to Silence Inhibit Yes. Each press of the 2  
key will cause the display to toggle between the two options.  
Synced Type  
NAC #  
1=SYNC TYPE  
If synchronized strobes were selected as the Type of device installed, the type of synchronization  
must be selected in this option. Pressing 1 while viewing NAC Screen #4 will cause the following  
screen to be displayed:  
NAC Screen #4  
NAC SYNC TYPE  
1=SYSTEM SENSOR  
2=WHEELOCK  
3=GENTEX  
Pressing 1 while viewing this screen will select System Sensor synchronization, 2 will select Whee-  
lock, and 3 will select Gentex.  
Maximum Number of Strobes for Synchronization  
The total current draw for each Notification Appliance Circuit cannot exceed 3.0 amps. Refer to  
the manufacturer’s documentation supplied with the Strobes to determine the maximum current  
draw for each strobe and ensure that the circuit maximum is not exceeded.  
To ensure proper strobe and circuit operation, there is also a limit to the number of strobes that can  
be attached to each circuit. Following is a list of the strobes that have been tested with this FACP  
and the maximum number that can be connected to each NAC. Make sure that the NAC maximum  
current is not exceeded:  
• System Sensor: 46 Strobes  
• Wheelock: 42 Strobes  
• Gentex: 39 Strobes  
Relays  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=TIMERS  
2=NAC  
Pressing 3 while viewing System Setup Screen #2 allows the programmer to configure two of the  
3=RELAYS  
main circuit board Form-C relays from the following screen:  
System Setup Screen #2  
RELAYS  
1=RELAY 1  
2=RELAY 2  
3=RELAY 3  
Relays Selection Screen  
112  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
To program Relay 1 or Relay 3, press the number corresponding to the selected relay. Note that  
Relay 2 is fixed as a Trouble relay. Selecting Relay 2 will have no effect on its programming. The  
following screen will appear for each relay to be programmed:  
RELAY #  
1=TYPE  
ALARM  
Relay Type Screen  
Pressing 1 for Type while viewing the Relay Screen will cause the following screens to be dis-  
played:  
RELAY  
RELAY  
1=TROUBLE  
2=COMM FAIL  
3=PROCESS MON  
1=ALARM  
2=SUPERVISORY  
3=SUPERVISORY AR  
Relay Screen #1  
Relay Screen #2  
RELAY  
RELAY  
1=MEDICAL  
2=SILENCEABLE ALARM  
1=PROCESS MON AR  
2=AC LOSS  
3=HAZARD  
Relay Screen #4  
Relay Screen #3  
While viewing the selected screen, press the number corresponding to the desired relay type to pro-  
gram the main circuit board relay. The choice will be stored in memory and the display will return  
to the Relay Type Screen which will show the programmed type choice. Press the Escape key to  
return to the Relays Selection Screen and repeat the preceding procedure for the remaining relays.  
Note the following:  
1. AR (AutoResettable) in SUPERVISORY AR and PROCESS MON AR means that a relay with  
the Supervisory and/or Process Monitor type code, when activated, will automatically reset  
when the corresponding condition is cleared.  
2. A relay programmed with the Silenceable Alarm type will activate upon any alarm and  
deactivate when the FACP Alarm Silenced LED is illuminated.  
Canadian Option  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=CANADIAN OPT. OFF  
2=WATERFLOW SIL. NO  
Pressing 1 while viewing System Setup Screen #3 will configure the FACP to comply with Cana-  
dian requirements. The display will change to Canadian Opt. On. Each press of the 1 key will  
cause the display to toggle between Canadian Opt. On and Canadian Opt. Off.:  
System Setup Screen #3  
SYSTEM SETUP  
1=CANADIAN OPT. OFF  
2=WATERFLOW SIL. NO  
Important! For Canadian Applications, this option must be set to ON prior to any other panel pro-  
gramming.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
The Canadian Options configures the FACP with the following as required by Canada:  
The following monitor module type codes are not available:  
• monitor  
• non-latching supervisory  
• non-latching drill  
• non-latching process monitor  
• process monitor  
• hazard  
• tornado  
• medical alert  
The auto-silence timer is fixed at 20 minutes and cannot be changed.  
Addressable ionization smoke detector sensitivity is automatically monitored using Canadian  
specifications.  
Waterflow Silenceable  
Pressing 2 while viewing System Setup Screen #3 will allow the programmer to configure the sys-  
tem for silenceable on nonsilenceable waterflow circuits. Each press of the 2 key will toggle the  
display between Waterflow Sil. No and Waterflow Sil. Yes. When Waterflow Sil. No is selected, all  
output devices associated with a waterflow type input device, will be nonsilenceable. When Water-  
flow Sil. Yes is selected, all output devices associated with a waterflow type input device, will be  
silenceable.  
3.6.6 Verify Loops  
PROGRAMMING  
1=LOOP SETUP  
Pressing 3 while viewing Programming Screen #2, will select the Verify Loops option and display  
2=SYSTEM SETUP  
3=VERIFY LOOPS  
the following screen:  
VERIFY LOOPS  
1=LOOP 1  
2=LOOP 2  
Programming Screen #2  
3=BOTH LOOPS  
Verify Loop Select Screen  
During loop verification, the FACP polls each device on the selected SLC to determine if the device  
is communicating and whether or not it responds with the proper type identification. The program-  
mer can choose to verify one or both loops by pressing the number corresponding to the choices  
shown above.  
When the selection is made, the following screen will be displayed while verification is in progress:  
VERIFYING LOOPS  
PLEASE WAIT  
Verification Progress Screen  
When Loop verification has been completed, the display will indicate that the system is OK or, if  
problems have been detected, any device type programming errors. Use the up and down arrow  
keys to view all detected errors.  
114  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
3.6.7 History  
PROGRAMMING  
1=HISTORY  
2=WALKTEST  
The History option allows an authorized user to view or erase events which have occurred in the  
control panel. Pressing 1 while viewing Programming Screen #3 will display the History options  
as shown in the following display:  
3=OPTION MODULES  
Programming Screen #3  
HISTORY  
1=VIEW EVENTS  
2=ERASE HISTORY  
History Screen  
View Events  
HISTORY  
1=VIEW EVENTS  
2=ERASE HISTORY  
Pressing 1 while viewing the History Screen will allow the user to select the events to be viewed as  
illustrated in the following:  
HISTORY  
History Screen  
1=VIEW ALL  
2=VIEW ALARMS  
3=VIEW OTHER EVENTS  
View Events Screen  
While displaying the View Events screen, press 1 to view all events, 2 to view only alarms, or 3 to  
view other events. Use the up and down arrow keys to scroll through all of the displayed events.  
Erase History  
The Erase History option allows a user to erase all events from the history file. This will provide a  
clean slate in order to use the history file to track future events. Pressing 2 while viewing the His-  
tory Screen will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
ERASE HISTORY  
PROCEED ?  
1=YES  
2=NO  
Erase History Screen  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Erase History Screen will erase all events from the History file. Dur-  
ing this process, the display will read as follows:  
ERASING HISTORY  
PLEASE WAIT  
Erase History Wait Screen  
After the History file has been erased, the display will return to the History Screen.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
3.6.8 Walktest  
PROGRAMMING  
1=HISTORY  
2=WALKTEST  
Walktest allows an individual to test the fire alarm system without the necessity to reset the control  
panel after each device activation. Pressing 2 while viewing the Programming Screen #3 will cause  
the following Walktest options to be displayed:  
3=OPTION MODULES  
Programming Screen #3  
WALKTEST  
1=SILENT  
2=AUDIBLE  
3=VIEW RESULT  
Walktest Screen  
To perform a silent walktest which will not sound the NACs, press 1 while viewing the Walktest  
Screen. To perform an audible walktest, which will sound the NACs, press 2 while viewing the  
Walktest Screen. When either option is chosen, the panel will enter Walktest Mode and the follow-  
ing screen will be displayed::  
UNIT IN WALKTEST  
1=VIEW WALKTEST LOG  
2=VIEW POINTS  
3=VIEW SUMMARY  
Unit In Walktest Screen  
From this screen, it is possible to view the walktest log, untested system points or a summary of the  
addressable devices tested during the current walktest. The user can select between any of these  
screens without interrupting the current walktest session. The walktest session will not end until  
the Unit In Walktest screen is exited by pressing the Escape key.  
Pressing 1 for View Walktest Log while viewing the Unit In Walktest screen will cause a screen sim-  
ilar to one of the following two screens to be displayed:  
ALARM: MONITOR  
NO EVENTS IN  
WALKTEST LOG  
NORTH CLASSROOM  
Z001  
10*15A 020510 1M006  
OR  
If there are no events in the current walktest session, the first screen will be displayed, indicating no  
events have been stored in the walktest log. If any events have been stored, a screen similar to the  
second will be displayed indicating the latest event. As walktest events occur, the display will  
change to indicate the latest event. All stored events can be scrolled on the screen by pressing the  
up or down arrow keys. To return to the first event, press the 1st Event key.  
116  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 2 for View Points while viewing the Unit In Walktest screen will display one of the follow-  
ing screens:  
UNTESTED POINTS 010  
NO POINTS IN  
SYSTEM  
1D001 SMOKE (PHOTO)  
*********************  
NOT TESTED  
OR  
If the system has no points installed, the first screen will be displayed. If points are installed, the  
second screen will be displayed, which allows the viewing of all untested system points and their  
status relating to the current walktest session. The up and down arrow keys will allow viewing of  
all untested points. If a point is tested while it is being displayed, the screen will update and display  
the next untested point. The first line indicates the total number of untested points. The second line  
displays information about an untested point. A description on the bottom of the screen will indi-  
cate if the displayed point has been disabled, if the Walktest option has been disabled for that point  
or if the point is not yet tested. The up and down arrow keys allow the user to scroll through all  
untested points.  
Pressing 3 for View Summary while viewing the Unit In Walktest screen will display a new screen  
which will show a total of the tested detectors, tested modules, untested detectors and untested  
modules for the current walktest session. If more than one SLC loop is installed on the FACP,  
pressing the down arrow key will display the Walktest summary for each SLC loop.  
The user can perform a one-person walktest by activating devices throughout the system. As each  
device is activated, the information about the activated device is stored in the Walktest Log. The  
information can be viewed by choosing one of the options from the Unit In Walktest screen.  
To end the Walktest session, press the Escape key to return to the Walktest screen. Pressing 3 for  
View Results while viewing the Walktest screen, after a walktest session has been completed, will  
allow the operator to view the final results of the most recent walktest. The following screen will  
be displayed:  
WALKTEST RESULTS  
View Result Screen  
Use the up and down arrow keys to view all of the walktest results which will be displayed. Note  
that the Walktest log is stored in RAM. If all power (AC and DC) is removed from the FACP, the  
Walktest log information will be lost. This information is also overwritten when subsequent walk-  
tests are performed.  
3.6.9 Option Modules  
PROGRAMMING  
1=HISTORY  
2=WALKTEST  
Options available for the FACP include ACS, Graphic, LED, Relay and LCD annunciators, printer  
connection for acquiring hardcopy printouts of panel data and PC (Personal Computer) connection  
for uploading and downloading panel data.  
3=OPTION MODULES  
Programming Screen #3  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 3 while viewing Programming Screen #3 will display the following screen:  
OPTION MODULES  
1=ANNUNCIATORS/UDACT  
2=ONBOARD DACT  
3=PRINTER/PC PR4800  
Options Screen  
Note that PR4800 in the display indicates that a supervised printer, configured for 4800 baud, has  
been previously programmed into the system.  
Annunciators/UDACT  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Options Screen will cause the control panel to display the following  
screens:  
ANNUNCIATORS  
1=TERM ENABLED  
2=ACS OPTIONS  
3=ANN-BUS OPTIONS  
NO  
Annunciator Screen  
A Terminal Mode annunciator, ACS Mode annunciator or ANN-BUS annunciator/module can be  
installed in the system. Do not use a mix of ACS annunciators and ANN annunciators since they  
use different communication protocols. ACS or ANN annunciators use the same TB6 terminal  
block connection. To install any of these devices, press the number corresponding to the desired  
device shown in the Annunciator Screen.  
Term Options  
While viewing the Annunciators Screen, each press of the 1 key for Term Options, will cause the  
display to toggle between Term Enabled No and Term Enabled Yes.  
NOTE: The LCD-80F is a Terminal Mode annunciator. To enable the FACP for LCD-80F  
operation, press 1 for Term Enabled Yes.  
118  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
ACS Options  
Programming  
ANNUNCIATORS  
1=TERM OPTIONS  
2=ACS OPTIONS  
Pressing 2 for ACS Options while viewing the Annunciators screen, will display the following  
screen:  
3=ANN-BUS OPTIONS  
Annunciator Screen  
ACS OPTIONS  
1=ACS ENABLED  
2=ACS INSTALLED  
3=UDACT  
NO  
NO  
Pressing 1 while viewing the ACS Options screen will cause the display to toggle between ACS  
Enabled Yes and ACS Enabled No. To install an ACS annunciator, the display must read ACS  
Enabled Yes.  
If ACS has been enabled, press 2 while viewing the ACS Options screen to select addresses for the  
ACS annunciators. The following screen will be displayed:  
ANNUNCIATOR  
1=ADDRESS 1  
2=ADDRESS 2  
3=ADDRESS 3  
YES  
NO  
NO  
ACS Installed Screen  
Pressing the down arrow key will allow the programmer to view additional screens displaying  
Addresses 1 -31. Each screen will indicate if an address has been used for an installed ACS annun-  
ciator. To select one or more addresses for the installed ACS annunciator(s), press the number key  
corresponding to the address in each screen. The display for the selected address will change from  
No to Yes. Each press of the number key will cause the display to toggle between No and Yes. The  
address of each installed annunciator must be enabled to allow communication between the FACP  
and annunciator.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Annunciator addressing is specific to the FACP control panel. The following table describes the  
annunciator addresses and the corresponding addressable devices that will be annunciated at each  
annunciator address.  
ACS Annunciator Address  
Annunciator Displays the Following Points  
8 General System Status Points & Zones 1 - 56  
Zones 57 - 99 & 4 NACs  
1
2
3
Loop 1, Module Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 2, Module Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 1, Module Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 2, Module Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 1, Module Addresses 129 - 159 & Loop 2 Module Addresses 129 - 159  
Loop 1, Detector Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 2, Detector Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 1, Detector Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 2, Detector Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 1 Detector Addresses 129 - 159 & Loop 2 Detector Addresses 129 - 159  
not used  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
not used  
not used  
not used  
not used  
not used  
not used  
8 General System Status Points & Zones 1 - 56  
Zones 57 - 99 & 4 NACs  
Loop 1, Module Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 2, Module Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 1, Module Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 2, Module Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 1, Module Addresses 129 - 159 & Loop 2 Module Addresses 129 - 159  
Loop 1, Detector Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 2, Detector Addresses 1 - 64  
Loop 1, Detector Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 2, Detector Addresses 65 - 128  
Loop 1 Detector Addresses 129 - 159 & Loop 2 Detector Addresses 129 - 159  
not used  
The 8 General System Status Points include the following:  
General Alarm  
General Trouble  
General Supervisory  
Alarm Silenced  
System Off Normal  
AC Loss  
Battery Fault  
NAC Fault  
Pressing 3 while viewing the ACS Options screen will toggle the display between UDACT NO and  
UDACT YES. This allows the connection of an external UDACT (Universal Digital Alarm Com-  
municator/Transmitter).  
120  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Master Programming Level  
ANN-BUS Options  
Programming  
ANNUNCIATORS  
1=TERM OPTIONS  
2=ACS OPTIONS  
Pressing 3 for ANN-BUS Options, while viewing the Annunciators screen, will cause the following  
screens to be displayed:.  
3=ANN-BUS OPTIONS  
Annunciator Screen  
ANN-BUS  
1=ENABLED  
NO  
2=MODULES INSTALLED  
3=AUTO-CONFIGURE  
ANN-BUS Screen #1  
ANN-BUS  
1=ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
2=ANN-80 OPTIONS  
ANN-BUS Screen #2  
A printer module, graphic annunciator module, LCD annunciator module, LED annunciator mod-  
ule and relay module can be programmed into the system. These devices communicate with the  
FACP over the ANN-BUS terminals on the control panel.  
ANN-BUS Enabled  
The ANN-BUS must be enabled if any modules are connected to the ANN-BUS terminals. To  
enable the ANN-BUS, press 1 while viewing ANN-BUS screen #1 so that the display reads  
Enabled Yes. Each press of the 1 key will cause the display to toggle between Enabled Yes and  
Enabled No.  
Modules Installed  
If an ANN-BUS module is installed, press 2 while viewing ANN-BUS screen #1 to select ANN-  
BUS addresses for the module(s). The following screen will be displayed.  
ANN-BUS MODULES  
1=ADDR. 1 NONE  
2=ADDR. 2 NONE  
3=ADDR. 3 NONE  
ANN-BUS Modules Screen #1  
Pressing the down arrow key will allow the programmer to view additional screens displaying  
Addresses 1-8. To program an ANN-BUS module to a specific address, press the number key cor-  
responding to the desired address in each screen. The following screen will be displayed for each  
address:  
ANN-BUS MODULES  
ANN-BUS ADDRESS #  
1=TYPE  
NONE  
ANN-BUS Address Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
Pressing 1 for Type will display the following screens:  
ANN-BUS MODULE TYPE  
1=NOT INSTALLED  
2=ANN-80 MODULE  
3=ANN-I/O MODULE  
Module Type Screen #1  
ANN-BUS MODULE TYPE  
1=ANN-S/PG MODULE  
2=ANN-LED MODULE  
3=ANN-RLY MODULE  
Module Type Screen #2  
ANN-BUS MODULE TYPE  
1=ANN-AUDIO  
Module Type Screen #3  
Press the number corresponding to the module type that is installed with the selected address.  
NOTE: If the module type selected is the ANN-80, ANN-S/PG, or ANN-AUDIO or if Not Installed  
is selected, the ANN-BUS Address Screen shown on the previous page will be displayed following  
the module selection. The options selected for each of these modules will be the same for all  
modules of the same type (refer to “ANN-S/PG (Print) Options” on page 132 and “ANN-80  
Options” on page 133).  
If ANN-I/O, ANN-LED or ANN-RLY is the selected module type, the following ANN-BUS  
Address Screen will be displayed:  
ANN-BUS MODULES  
ANN-BUS ADDRESS #  
1=TYPE ANN-I/O  
2=MODULE OPTIONS  
ANN-BUS Address Screen  
Since the options for each of these module types can be individually set, pressing 2 for Module  
Options, while viewing the ANN-BUS Address Screen will display the available options as  
described below.  
122  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-I/O Options  
Programming  
Pressing 2 for Module Options while viewing ANN-BUS Address Screen when the ANN-I/O  
option is selected will display the following screen:  
ANN-I/O ADDR #  
SLC 1 MOD 001-030  
ACTIVE LEDS ONLY  
ANN-I/O Address Screen #1  
ANN-I/O ADDR #  
1=POINT/ZONE POINT  
ANN-I/O Address Screen #2  
ANN-I/O ADDR #  
1=RANGE  
2=DET/MOD  
3=SLC LOOP #  
PT001-030  
MOD  
2
ANN-I/O Address Screen #3  
The first screen indicates that the ANN-I/O at the selected ANN-BUS address is programmed to  
annunciate SLC Loop #1 addressable modules with addresses 1 through 30. The programming can  
be changed using ANN-I/O Address Screens 2 and 3.  
Pressing 1 while viewing ANN-I/O Address Screen #2 will program the annunciator module to  
annunciate either Point (addressable device address) information or Zone information.  
Pressing 1 while viewing ANN-I/O Address Screen #3 will select the Point or Zone range to be  
annunciated (refer to the tables in “ANN-I/O Zone Option” on page 123 and “ANN-I/O Point  
Option” on page 125).  
Pressing 2 while viewing ANN-I/O Address Screen #3 will select either addressable detectors or  
addressable modules to be annunciated.  
Pressing 3 while viewing ANN-I/O Address Screen #3 will select the SLC loop with the address-  
able devices to be annunciated.  
ANN-I/O Zone Option  
If Zone is selected as the module option, the first ten LEDs on the first ANN-I/O module will dis-  
play the system status information. The remaining 30 LEDs on the first module and 40 LEDs on  
the remaining modules will display the active/alarm status of each zone in the Zone Range pro-  
grammed for that particular module. The LED assignments for each ANN-I/O module will be as  
follows.  
ANN-I/O Module #1  
Function  
ANN-I/O Module #2  
Function  
ANN-I/O Module #3  
Function  
Module LED  
1
2
3
AC Fault  
Fire Alarm  
Supervisory  
Zone 30  
Zone 31  
Zone 32  
Zone 70  
Zone 71  
Zone 72  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
4
Trouble  
Alarm Silenced  
Earth Fault  
Battery Fault  
Charger Fault  
NAC Fault  
Disabled  
Zone 00  
Zone 01  
Zone 02  
Zone 03  
Zone 04  
Zone 05  
Zone 06  
Zone 07  
Zone 08  
Zone 09  
Zone 10  
Zone 11  
Zone 33  
Zone 34  
Zone 35  
Zone 36  
Zone 37  
Zone 38  
Zone 39  
Zone 40  
Zone 41  
Zone 42  
Zone 43  
Zone 44  
Zone 45  
Zone 46  
Zone 47  
Zone 48  
Zone 49  
Zone 50  
Zone 51  
Zone 52  
Zone 53  
Zone 54  
Zone 55  
Zone 56  
Zone 57  
Zone 58  
Zone 59  
Zone 60  
Zone 61  
Zone 62  
Zone 63  
Zone 64  
Zone 65  
Zone 66  
Zone 67  
Zone 68  
Zone 69  
Zone 73  
Zone 74  
Zone 75  
Zone 76  
Zone 77  
Zone 78  
Zone 79  
Zone 80  
Zone 81  
Zone 82  
Zone 83  
Zone 84  
Zone 85  
Zone 86  
Zone 87  
Zone 88  
Zone 89  
Zone 90  
Zone 91  
Zone 92  
Zone 93  
Zone 94  
Zone 95  
Zone 96  
Zone 97  
Zone 98  
Zone 99  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
Zone 12  
Zone 13  
Zone 14  
Zone 15  
Zone 16  
Zone 17  
Zone 18  
Zone 19  
Zone 20  
Zone 21  
Zone 22  
Zone 23  
Zone 24  
Zone 25  
Zone 26  
Zone 27  
Zone 28  
Zone 29  
124  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-I/O Point Option  
Programming  
If Point is selected as the module option, the first ten LEDs on the first ANN-I/O module will  
display the system status information. The remaining 30 LEDs on the first module and 40 LEDs on  
each additional module will display the active/alarm status of each point in the Point Range  
programmed for that particular module. The points that will be annunciated on a particular ANN-  
I/O module depend on the programming options selected as far as which SLC loop and the device  
type (detector or module) to be annunciated. The LED assignments for each ANN-I/O module will  
be as follows.  
ANN-I/O  
Module #1  
Function  
ANN-I/O  
Module #2  
Function  
ANN-I/O  
Module #3  
Function  
ANN-I/O  
Module #4  
Function  
ANN-I/O  
Module #5  
Function  
Module LED  
1
AC Fault  
Fire Alarm  
Supervisory  
Trouble  
Point 31  
Point 32  
Point 33  
Point 34  
Point 35  
Point 36  
Point 37  
Point 38  
Point 39  
Point 40  
Point 41  
Point 42  
Point 43  
Point 44  
Point 45  
Point 46  
Point 47  
Point 48  
Point 49  
Point 50  
Point 51  
Point 52  
Point 53  
Point 54  
Point 55  
Point 56  
Point 57  
Point 58  
Point 59  
Point 60  
Point 61  
Point 62  
Point 63  
Point 64  
Point 65  
Point 66  
Point 67  
Point 68  
Point 69  
Point 70  
Point 71  
Point 72  
Point 73  
Point 74  
Point 75  
Point 76  
Point 77  
Point 78  
Point 79  
Point 80  
Point 81  
Point 82  
Point 83  
Point 84  
Point 85  
Point 86  
Point 87  
Point 88  
Point 89  
Point 90  
Point 91  
Point 92  
Point 93  
Point 94  
Point 95  
Point 96  
Point 97  
Point 98  
Point 99  
Point 100  
Point 101  
Point 102  
Point 103  
Point 104  
Point 105  
Point 106  
Point 107  
Point 108  
Point 109  
Point 110  
Point 111  
Point 112  
Point 113  
Point 114  
Point 115  
Point 116  
Point 117  
Point 118  
Point 119  
Point 120  
Point 121  
Point 122  
Point 123  
Point 124  
Point 125  
Point 126  
Point 127  
Point 128  
Point 129  
Point 130  
Point 131  
Point 132  
Point 133  
Point 134  
Point 135  
Point 136  
Point 137  
Point 138  
Point 139  
Point 140  
Point 141  
Point 142  
Point 143  
Point 144  
Point 145  
Point 146  
Point 147  
Point 148  
Point 149  
Point 150  
Point 151  
Point 152  
Point 153  
Point 154  
Point 155  
Point 156  
Point 157  
Point 158  
Point 159  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
2
3
4
5
Alarm Silenced  
Earth Fault  
Battery Fault  
Charger Fault  
NAC Fault  
Disabled  
Point 01  
Point 02  
Point 03  
Point 04  
Point 05  
Point 06  
Point 07  
Point 08  
Point 09  
Point 10  
Point 11  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
Point 12  
Point 13  
Point 14  
Point 15  
Point 16  
Point 17  
Point 18  
Point 19  
Point 20  
Point 21  
Point 22  
Point 23  
Point 24  
Point 25  
Point 26  
Point 27  
Point 28  
Point 29  
Point 30  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-LED Options  
Pressing 2 for Module Options while viewing ANN-BUS Address Screen when the ANN-LED  
option is selected will display the following screen:  
ANN-LED ADDR #  
LOOP1 DET 1-10  
ALARM,SUPERV,TBL  
ANN-LED Address Screen #1  
ANN-LED ADDR #  
1=POINT/ZONE  
2=ALARM/ATS  
ANN-LED Address Screen #2  
ANN-LED ADDR #  
1=RANGE  
2=DET/MOD  
3=LOOP#  
ANN-LED Address Screen #3  
The first screen indicates that the ANN-LED at the selected ANN-BUS address is programmed to  
annunciate Alarms, Supervisories and Troubles for SLC Loop #1 addressable Detectors with  
addresses 1 through 10. The programming can be changed using ANN-LED Address Screens 2  
and 3.  
Pressing 1 while viewing ANN-LED Address Screen #2 will program the annunciator module to  
annunciate either Point (addressable device address) information or Zone information.  
Pressing 2 while viewing ANN-LED Address Screen #2 will program the annunciator module to  
annunciate only Alarms for addressable device addresses 1-30 or Alarms, Supervisories and Trou-  
bles for addressable device addresses 1-10.  
Pressing 1 while viewing ANN-LED Address Screen #3 will select the Point or Zone range to be  
Pressing 2 while viewing ANN-LED Address Screen #3 will select either addressable detectors or  
addressable modules to be annunciated.  
Pressing 3 while viewing ANN-LED Address Screen #3 will select the SLC loop with the address-  
able devices to be annunciated.  
126  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-LED Zone Option - Alarm Only (for use with ANN-RLED module)  
Programming  
If Zone is selected as the module option, and the module is programmed to annunciate alarms only,  
the first ten LEDs on the first ANN-LED module will display the system status information. The  
remaining 30 LEDs on the first module and the last 30 LEDs on the remaining modules will display  
the active/alarm status of each zone in the Zone Range programmed for that particular module. The  
LED assignments for each ANN-LED module will be as follows.  
Alarm Silenced  
Earth Fault  
NAC 1 Fault  
Battery Fault  
NAC 2 Fault  
NAC 3 Fault  
Disabled  
NAC 4 Fault  
Maintenance  
Charger Fault  
Zone 00  
Zone 01  
Zone 02  
Zone 03  
Zone 04  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 05  
Zone 06  
Zone 07  
Zone 08  
Zone 09  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 10  
Zone 11  
Zone 12  
Zone 13  
Zone 14  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 15  
Zone 16  
Zone 17  
Zone 18  
Zone 19  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 20  
Zone 21  
Zone 22  
Zone 23  
Zone 24  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 25  
Zone 26  
Zone 27  
Zone 28  
Zone 29  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
ANN-RLED Module #1  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Zone 31  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Zone 32  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Zone 30  
Zone 33  
Zone 34  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 35  
Zone 36  
Zone 37  
Zone 38  
Zone 39  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 40  
Zone 41  
Zone 42  
Zone 43  
Zone 44  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 45  
Zone 46  
Zone 47  
Zone 48  
Zone 49  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 50  
Zone 51  
Zone 52  
Zone 53  
Zone 54  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 55  
Zone 56  
Zone 57  
Zone 58  
Zone 59  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
ANN-RLED Module #2  
The LED assignments for the modules annunciating Zone Ranges 60 - 89 and 90 - 99, will follow  
the same pattern as the second ANN-RLED module.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-LED Zone Option - Alarm, Trouble and Supervisory  
If Zone is selected as the module option, and the module is programmed to annunciate alarms,  
troubles and supervisories, the first ten LEDs on the first ANN-LED module will display the sys-  
tem status information. The remaining 30 LEDs on the first module and the last 30 LEDs on the  
remaining modules will display the alarm, trouble and supervisory status for each of the ten zones  
in the Zone Range programmed for that particular module. The LED assignments for each ANN-  
LED module will be as follows.  
Alarm Silenced  
Earth Fault  
NAC 1 Fault  
Battery Fault  
NAC 2 Fault  
NAC 3 Fault  
Disabled  
NAC 4 Fault  
Maintenance  
Charger Fault  
Zone 00  
Zone 01  
Zone 02  
Zone 03  
Zone 04  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 00  
Trouble  
Zone 01  
Trouble  
Zone 02  
Trouble  
Zone 03  
Trouble  
Zone 04  
Trouble  
Zone 00  
Zone 01  
Zone 02  
Zone 13  
Zone 04  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Zone 05  
Zone 06  
Zone 07  
Zone 08  
Zone 09  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 05  
Trouble  
Zone 06  
Trouble  
Zone 07  
Trouble  
Zone 08  
Trouble  
Zone 09  
Trouble  
Zone 05  
Zone 06  
Zone 07  
Zone 08  
Zone 09  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
ANN-LED Module #1  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Zone 10  
Zone 11  
Zone 12  
Zone 13  
Zone 14  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 10  
Trouble  
Zone 11  
Trouble  
Zone 12  
Trouble  
Zone 13  
Trouble  
Zone 14  
Trouble  
Zone 10  
Zone 11  
Zone 12  
Zone 13  
Zone 14  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Zone 15  
Zone 16  
Zone 17  
Zone 18  
Zone 19  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Zone 15  
Trouble  
Zone 16  
Trouble  
Zone 17  
Trouble  
Zone 18  
Trouble  
Zone 19  
Trouble  
Zone 15  
Zone 16  
Zone 17  
Zone 18  
Zone 19  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
ANN-LED Module #2  
The LED assignments for the modules annunciating Zone Ranges 20 - 29, 30 - 39, 40 - 49, 50 - 59,  
60 - 69, 70 - 79, 80 - 89 and 90 - 99, will follow the same pattern as the second ANN-LED module.  
128  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-LED Point Option - Alarm Only (for use with ANN-RLED module)  
Programming  
If Point is selected as the module option and the module is programmed to annunciate alarms only,  
the first ten LEDs on the first ANN-LED module will display the system status information. The  
remaining 30 LEDs on the first module and the last 30 LEDs on each additional module will dis-  
play the active/alarm status of each point in the Point Range programmed for that particular mod-  
ule. The points that will be annunciated on a particular ANN-LED module depend on the  
programming options selected as far a which SLC loop and the device type (detector or module) to  
be annunciated. The LED assignments for each ANN-LED module will be as follows.  
Alarm Silenced  
Earth Fault  
NAC 1 Fault  
Battery Fault  
NAC 2 Fault  
NAC 3 Fault  
Disabled  
NAC 4 Fault  
Maintenance  
Charger Fault  
Point 01  
Point 02  
Point 03  
Point 04  
Point 05  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 06  
Point 07  
Point 08  
Point 09  
Point 10  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 11  
Point 12  
Point 13  
Point 14  
Point 15  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 16  
Point 17  
Point 18  
Point 19  
Point 20  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 21  
Point 22  
Point 23  
Point 24  
Point 25  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 26  
Point 27  
Point 28  
Point 29  
Point 30  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
ANN-RLED Module #1 (Point Range 01 - 30)  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Point 31  
Point 32  
Point 33  
Point 34  
Point 35  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 36  
Point 37  
Point 38  
Point 39  
Point 40  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 41  
Point 42  
Point 43  
Point 44  
Point 45  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 46  
Point 47  
Point 48  
Point 49  
Point 50  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 51  
Point 52  
Point 53  
Point 64  
Point 55  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 56  
Point 57  
Point 58  
Point 59  
Point 60  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
ANN-RLED Module #2 (Point Range 31 - 60)  
The LED assignments for the modules annunciating Point Ranges 61 - 90, 91 - 120, 121 - 150, and  
151 - 159, will follow the same pattern as the second ANN-RLED module.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-LED Point Option - Alarm, Trouble and Supervisory  
If Point is selected as the module option, and the module is programmed to annunciate alarms,  
troubles and supervisories, the first ten LEDs on the first ANN-LED module will display the sys-  
tem status information. The remaining 30 LEDs on the first module and the last 30 LEDs on the  
remaining modules will display the alarm, trouble and supervisory status for each of the ten zones  
in the Point Range programmed for that particular module. The LED assignments for each ANN-  
LED module will be as follows.  
Alarm Silenced  
Earth Fault  
NAC 1 Fault  
Battery Fault  
NAC 2 Fault  
NAC 3 Fault  
Disabled  
NAC 4 Fault  
Maintenance  
Charger Fault  
Point 01  
Point 02  
Point 03  
Point 04  
Point 05  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 01  
Trouble  
Point 02  
Trouble  
Point 03  
Trouble  
Point 04  
Trouble  
Point 05  
Trouble  
Point 01  
Point 02  
Point 03  
Point 04  
Point 05  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Point 06  
Point 07  
Point 08  
Point 09  
Point 10  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 06  
Trouble  
Point 07  
Trouble  
Point 08  
Trouble  
Point 09  
Trouble  
Point 10  
Trouble  
Point 06  
Point 07  
Point 08  
Point 09  
Point 10  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
ANN-LED Module #1 (Point Range 01 - 10)  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Point 11  
Point 12  
Point 13  
Point 14  
Point 15  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 11  
Trouble  
Point 12  
Trouble  
Point 13  
Trouble  
Point 14  
Trouble  
Point 15  
Trouble  
Point 11  
Point 12  
Point 13  
Point 14  
Point 15  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Point 16  
Point 17  
Point 18  
Point 19  
Point 20  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Active/Alarm  
Point 16  
Trouble  
Point 17  
Trouble  
Point 18  
Trouble  
Point 19  
Trouble  
Point 20  
Trouble  
Point 16  
Point 17  
Point 18  
Point 19  
Point 20  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
Supervisory  
ANN-LED Module #2 (Point Range 11 - 20)  
The LED assignments for the modules annunciating Point Ranges 21 - 30, 31 - 40 and 41 - 50, 51 -  
60, 61 - 70, 71 - 80, 81 - 90, 91 - 100, 101 - 110, 111, 120, 121 - 130, 131 - 140, 141 - 150 and  
151 - 159, will follow the same pattern as the second ANN-LED Module.  
130  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-RLY Options  
Programming  
Pressing 2 for Module Options while viewing ANN-BUS Address Screen when the ANN-RLY  
option is selected will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
ANN-RLY - ADDR. #  
1=RELAY 1  
2=RELAY 2  
3=RELAY 3  
ZONE 00  
ZONE 01  
ZONE 02  
ANN-RLY Options Screen  
The ANN-RLY module provides ten Form-C relays which can be programmed for various func-  
tions. The initial screen displays Relays 1 through 3. Pressing the down arrow key will display the  
remaining relays for this module.  
To program any of the ANN-RLY relays, while viewing the appropriate ANN-RLY Option screen,  
press the number key corresponding to the relay to be programmed. Following is a list of the avail-  
able programming options for each relay:  
Alarm  
Supervisory  
Supervisory AR  
Trouble  
Comm Fail  
Process Mon  
Process Mon AR  
AC Loss  
Hazard  
Medical  
Silenceable Alarm  
Zone Active XX  
Auto-Configure  
ANN-BUS  
1=ANN ENABLED  
2=OPTIONS INSTALLED  
3=AUTO-CONFIGURE  
The ANN-BUS Auto-Configure features allows the programmer to quickly bring all installed  
ANN-BUS modules online. The software will search for all ANN-BUS modules and automatically  
program the device type and address into the system. The ANN-BUS must be enabled for the Auto-  
Configure feature to work.  
ANN-BUS Screen #1  
Pressing 3 while viewing ANN-BUS Screen #1 will begin the Auto-Configure process and cause  
the following screen to be displayed:  
ANN-BUS  
AUTO-CONGFIGURE  
IN PROGRESS  
PLEASE WAIT  
Auto-Configure Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-S/PG (Print) Options  
ANN-BUS  
1=ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
2=ANN-80 OPTIONS  
The Print option allows the programmer to configure the optional printer. Pressing 1 while viewing  
ANN-BUS screen #2 will display the following screens:  
ANN-BUS Screen #2  
ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
1=PORT  
PAR  
2=PRINTER SUPV NO  
3=OFFLINE TIMER 60  
ANN-S/PG Options Screen #1  
ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
1=BAUD RATE  
2=DATA BITS  
3=PARITY  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
ANN-S/PG Options Screen #2  
ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
1=STOP BITS  
N/A  
ANN-S/PG Options Screen #3  
Pressing 1 for Port while viewing ANN-S/PG Options screen #1 will allow the programmer to  
select between a Parallel and Serial Port for printer connection. Each press of the 1 key will cause  
the display to toggle between Port PAR (parallel) and Port SER (serial). It is important to note that  
the interface selected determines which options are available to the user.  
If the Parallel Port option is selected, the user has the option to supervise the printer and select an  
offline timer for the supervision by pressing 2 for Printer Supervision while viewing Print Options  
screen #1. Each press of the 2 key will cause the display to toggle between Printer Supv NO for no  
supervision and Printer Supv YES for printer supervision. Note that this option is not selectable if  
the Serial Port option has been selected.  
If the Parallel Port option is selected, the user has the ability to select an Offline Timer by pressing  
3 while viewing Print Options screen #1. The resultant screen allows the programmer to program  
the Offline Timer for a delay of between 0 and 255 seconds before loss of printer supervision is  
reported as a trouble.  
If the Serial Port option is selected, the Printer Supv and Offline Timer options will not be available.  
The Baud Rate, Data Bits, Parity and Stop Bits options are only available when the Serial Port  
option has been selected.  
Pressing 1 for Baud Rate while viewing ANN-S/PG Options screen #2 will cause a screen to appear  
which allow the user to select a Baud Rate of 19200, 9600, or 2400.  
Pressing 2 for Data Bits while viewing ANN-S/PG Options screen #2 will cause a screen to appear  
which allows the user to select 7 or 8 Data Bits.  
Pressing 3 for Parity while viewing ANN-S/PG Options screen #2 will cause a screen to appear  
which allows the user to select between No Parity, Even Parity, or Odd Parity.  
Pressing 1 for Stop Bits while viewing ANN-S/PG Options screen #3 will cause a screen to appear  
which allows the user to select between 1.0 or 2.0 Stop Bits.  
132  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Master Programming Level  
ANN-80 Options  
Programming  
ANN-BUS  
1=ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
2=ANN-80 OPTIONS  
Pressing 2 while viewing ANN-BUS screen #2 will display the following screen:  
ANN-80 OPTIONS  
1=PIEZO ENABLE  
2=LOCK ENABLE  
3=ACK BTN ENABLE  
ANN-BUS Screen #2  
ANN-80 Options Screen #1  
ANN-80 OPTIONS  
1=SIL BTN ENABLE  
2=RST BTN ENABLE  
3=DRL BTN ENABLE  
ANN-80 Options Screen #2  
The Piezo Enable option allows the programmer to select whether the piezo sounder on any  
installed ANN-80 module will ever sound. Pressing 1 while viewing the ANN-80 Options Screen  
#1 causes the display to toggle between Piezo Enable Yes and Piezo Enable No.  
The Lock Enable option allows the programmer to select whether or not any installed ANN-80  
annunciator must be unlocked by its key before any annunciator key presses will function. Pressing  
2 while viewing the ANN-80 Options Screen #1 causes the display to toggle between Lock Enable  
Yes (annunciator must be unlocked for keys to function) and Lock Enable No (lock position is  
ignored).  
The Acknowledge Button Enable (ACK BTN ENABLE) option allows the programmer to select  
whether the Ack/Step button on any installed ANN-80 annunciator will function normally or  
always be ignored. Pressing 3 while viewing the ANN-80 Options Screen #1 causes the display to  
toggle between Ack Btn Enable Yes (Ack/Step button functions normally) and Ack Btn Enable No  
(Ack/Step button never functions).  
The Silence Button Enable (SIL BTN ENABLE) option allows the programmer to select whether the  
Silence button on any installed ANN-80 annunciator will function normally or always be ignored.  
Pressing 1 while viewing the ANN-80 Options Screen #2 causes the display to toggle between Sil  
Btn Enable Yes (Silence button functions normally) and Sil Btn Enable No (Silence button never  
functions).  
The Reset Button Enable (RST BTN ENABLE) option allows the programmer to select whether the  
Reset button on any installed ANN-80 annunciator will function normally or always be ignored.  
Pressing 2 while viewing the ANN-80 Options Screen #2 causes the display to toggle between Rst  
Btn Enable Yes (Reset button functions normally) and Rst Btn Enable No (Reset button never func-  
tions).  
The Drill Button Enable (DRL BTN ENABLE) option allows the programmer to select whether the  
Drill button on any installed ANN-80 annunciator will function normally or always be ignored.  
Pressing 3 while viewing the ANN-80 Options Screen #2 causes the display to toggle between Drl  
Btn Enable Yes (Drill button functions normally) and Drl Btn Enable No (Drill button never func-  
tions).  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
On Board DACT  
OPTION MODULES  
1=ANNUNCIATORS/UDACT  
2=ON BOARD DACT  
The Onboard DACT (Digital Alarm Communicator/Transmitter) provides communication to a  
Central Station. Pressing 2 while viewing the Option Module Screen will allow programming of  
the Onboard DACT. Refer to the DACT-UD2 Installation and Programming Manual Document  
#53037 for detailed information on installing and programming this option.  
3=PRINTER/PC  
NO  
Option Module Screen  
Printer/PC  
A Printer or a PC can be connected to the control panel. Pressing 3 while viewing the Option Mod-  
ule Screen will cause the following screen to appear:  
PRINTER-PC  
1=PRINTER NO SU NO  
2=PRINTER SU YES  
3=PC  
NO  
Printer-PC Screen  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Printer-PC Screen will program the control panel for an unsupervised  
(NO SU) printer. The display will change to the Printer Baud Rate Screen as shown below.  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Printer-PC Screen will program the control panel for a supervised  
(SU) printer. Printer supervision, when enabled, will typically detect the removal of the printer  
cable and will detect when the printer power has been turned off. Depending upon the brand of  
printer, other errors such as paper empty or printer off-line may be detected.  
Enabling either printer option will cause the following screen to appear, which allows the program-  
mer to select the baud rate for the printer communication:  
PRINTER BAUD RATE  
1=2400 BAUD  
2=4800 BAUD  
3=9600 BAUD  
Printer Baud Rate Screen  
Pressing the number key corresponding to the desired baud rate (2 for 4800 Baud for example) will  
program the control panel for the selected baud rate and return the display to the Option Module  
Screen which will indicate Printer/PC PR4800 for a supervised printer installed at 4800 baud rate.  
Pressing 3 while viewing the Printer-PC Screen will program the control panel for a PC connection.  
The display will return to the Option Module Screen which will indicate Printer/PC PC for per-  
sonal computer installed.  
134  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
3.6.10 Password Change  
PROGRAMMING  
1=PASSWORD CHANGE  
2=CLEAR PROGRAM  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
The factory set passwords, which have been programmed into the control panel, can be changed by  
selecting the Password Change option. Pressing 1 while viewing Programming Screen #4 will  
cause the following screen to be displayed:  
Programming Screen #4  
PASSWORD CHANGE  
1=MASTER  
2=MAINTENANCE  
3=REMOTE DOWNLOAD  
Password Change Screen  
Press 1 to change the Master Programming Level password, 2 to change the Maintenance Level  
password, or 3 to change the Remote Download password. Note that the passwords will not be dis-  
played on LCD annunciators.  
The following screen will appear when either change option is selected:  
ENTER NEW FIVE DIGIT  
PASSWORD  
Enter Password Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear in the center of the display. Enter a new five digit password (such as  
10101 for the Master Level). After the fifth digit is entered, the following screen will be displayed:  
VERIFY NEW  
PASSWORD  
Password Change Screen  
Re-enter the new password to accept the change. The display will return to the initial Password  
Change Screen.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Master Programming Level  
3.6.11 Clear Program  
PROGRAMMING  
1=PASSWORD CHANGE  
2=CLEAR PROGRAM  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
Pressing 2 while viewing Programming Screen #4, will select the Clear Program option. This will  
cause the LCD to display the following screens:  
Programming Screen #4  
CLEAR PROGRAM  
1=WHOLE SYSTEM  
2=ALL LOOPS  
3=LOOP1  
Clear Program Screen #1  
CLEAR PROGRAM  
1=LOOP2  
Clear Program Screen #2  
Pressing 1, for Whole System while viewing the Clear Program Screen #1, will clear all general  
system programming options and all programmed addressable devices from the nonvolatile mem-  
ory of the FACP. This function is useful when the control panel is first installed, prior to autopro-  
gramming. Note that it is necessary to autoprogram after using the Clear Whole System function.  
Pressing 2, for All Loops while viewing the Clear Program Screen #1, will clear all programming  
related to all SLC loops and connected addressable devices.  
Pressing 3, for Loop 1 while viewing the Clear Program Screen #1, will clear only the program-  
ming related to SLC Loop 1 and the connected addressable devices.  
Pressing 1, for Loop 2 while viewing the Clear Program Screen #2, will clear only the program-  
ming related to SLC Loop 2 and the connected addressable devices.  
Before executing any of the Clear commands listed above, the control panel will provide a warning  
to the user by prompting with the following display:  
WARNING!  
SYSTEM CHANGE  
PROCEED?  
1=YES  
2=NO  
Pressing 1 will cause the control panel to carry out the selected clear option. Pressing 2 will pre-  
vent programming from being cleared.  
136  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Master Programming Level  
Programming  
3.6.12 Program Check  
PROGRAMMING  
The Program Check feature allows the programmer to view the zones which have been pro-  
1=PASSWORD CHANGE  
2=CLEAR PROGRAM  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
grammed to the Notification Appliance Circuits on the control panel but have not been pro-  
grammed to Initiating Devices as well as other circuits with no input or output correlations.  
Pressing 3 while viewing Programming Screen #4 will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
Programming Screen #4  
PROGRAM CHECK  
1=NACS NO INPUT  
2=ZONES NO INPUT  
3=ZONES NO OUTPUT  
PROGRAM CHECK  
1=NACS NO INPUT  
2=ZONES NO INPUT  
3=ZONES NO OUTPUT  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Program Check screen will display an NAC screen similar to the fol-  
lowing.  
Program Check Screen  
NACS NO INPUT  
NAC 1  
25 31 44 55 67  
The example above indicates that NAC 1 has been programmed to Zones 25, 31, 44, 55 and 67 but  
no input devices have been programmed to any of these zones. Use the up and down arrow keys to  
view all the NAC zones without input assignments for NAC 1, NAC 2, NAC 3, and NAC 4.  
NOTE: If the NACs have been configured for Class Ain the setup option, only NAC1 and NAC2 will  
display test information. NAC3 and NAC4 will display asterisks (*) and will not be included in the test.  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Program Check screen will display a screen similar to the following:  
ZONES NO INPUT  
05 07 09 10 11 1M001  
The Zone No Input screen allows the programmer to view the zones which have not been pro-  
grammed to at least one input device (not including general alarm Zone 00). The example in the  
preceding screen indicates that Zones 05, 07, 09, 10, and 11 have been programmed to an address-  
able module (control module in this example) with an address of 001 on loop 1 but have not been  
programmed to any input devices. Use the up and down arrow keys to view all the zones without  
input assignments.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Maintenance Programming Level  
Pressing 3 while viewing Program Check screen will cause a screen similar to the following to be  
displayed:  
ZONES NO OUTPUT  
05 07 09 10 11 1D001  
The Zone No Output feature allows the programmer to view the zones which have not been pro-  
grammed to at least one output device (not including general alarm Zone 00). The example in the  
preceding screen indicates that Zones 05, 07, 09, 10, and 11 have been programmed to an address-  
able detector with an address of 001 on loop 1 but have not been programmed to any output  
devices. Use the up and down arrow keys to view all the zones without output assignments.  
3.7 Maintenance Programming Level  
To access Maintenance Programming mode, press the Enter key. The LCD will display the follow-  
ing:  
1=READ STATUS  
2=PROGRAMMING  
3=REMOTE DOWNLOAD  
To enter the Maintenance Programming mode, press 2. The display will read as follows:  
PROGRAMMING  
ENTER PASSWORD  
When the Maintenance level password (default 11111) is entered, the following screen will appear:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=POINT PROGRAM  
2=HISTORY  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
138  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintenance Programming Level  
Programming  
Note that in the preceding screens, an arrow appears to inform the programmer that additional  
options can be viewed by pressing the keypad down arrow key, as shown in the following screen.  
PROGRAMMING  
1=WALKTEST  
2=SYSTEM  
3=ZONE SETUP  
3.7.1 Disable Point  
Pressing 1 for Point Program, while viewing Maintenance Screen #1 will cause the following  
screens to be displayed:  
PROGRAMMING  
1=POINT PROGRAM  
2=HISTORY  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
POINT PROGRAM  
1=LOOP 1  
2=LOOP 2  
Maintenance Screen #1  
Loop Select Screen  
Select the Loop, containing the device to be disabled, by pressing 1 for Loop 1 or 2 for Loop 2. A  
screen will then be displayed, allowing the operator to select the type of addressable device to be  
disabled as shown in the following display:  
POINT PROGRAM  
1=DETECTOR  
2=MODULE  
Device Select Screen  
Select the device type by pressing 1 for an addressable detector or 2 for an addressable module.  
The operator will be prompted to enter the three digit device address as shown in the following  
example for a detector:  
EDIT DETECTOR  
ENTER POINT ADDRESS  
***  
Address Select Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Maintenance Programming Level  
A flashing cursor will appear in the bottom left corner of the display, prompting for the three digit  
device address. When the third digit is enter, 001 for example, a screen will appear which will  
allow enabling or disabling of the selected point, as illustrated in the following example:  
EDIT DETECTOR 1D001  
1=ENABLED  
YES  
Enable/Disable Select Screen  
Pressing 1 repeatedly will cause the display to toggle between Enabled Yes and Enabled No.  
3.7.2 History  
PROGRAMMING  
1=POINT PROGRAM  
2=HISTORY  
Pressing 2 while viewing Maintenance Screen #1 will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
HISTORY  
1=VIEW EVENTS  
2=ERASE HISTORY  
Maintenance Screen #1  
History Screen  
The History feature allows the operator to view control panel events which have been stored in a  
history file in memory and erase the contents of the history file  
Pressing 1 while viewing the History screen will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
HISTORY  
1=VIEW ALL  
2=VIEW ALARMS  
3=VIEW OTHER EVENTS  
Events Screen  
To view all the events which have occurred in the control panel since the history file was last  
erased, press 1 while viewing the Events screen. To view only alarms which have occurred, press 2  
while viewing the Events screen. To view events other than alarms, press 3. The most recent event  
will be displayed on the screen. To view all of the selected events, press the up or down arrow keys  
to scroll through the list of events. If no events have occurred, the display will read NO EVENTS  
IN HISTORY.  
140  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance Programming Level  
Programming  
Pressing 2 while viewing the History Screen will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
ERASE HISTORY  
PROCEED ?  
1=YES  
2=NO  
Erase History Screen  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Erase History Screen will cause the message ERASING HISTORY,  
PLEASE WAIT to be displayed. The display will then return to the History Screen. Pressing 2 will  
cause the display to return to the History Screen without erasing the History file.  
3.7.3 Program Check  
PROGRAMMING  
1=POINT PROGRAM  
2=HISTORY  
Pressing 3 while viewing Maintenance Screen #1 will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
3=PROGRAM CHECK  
PROGRAM CHECK  
1=NACS NO INPUT  
Maintenance Screen #1  
2=ZONES NO INPUT  
3=ZONES NO OUTPUT  
Program Check Screen  
The Program Check feature allows the programmer to view the zones which have been pro-  
grammed to the Notification Appliance Circuits on the control panel but have not been pro-  
grammed to Initiating Devices as well as other circuits with no input or output correlations.  
Pressing 1 while viewing Program Check screen will cause a screen similar to the following to be  
displayed.  
NACS NO INPUT  
NAC 1  
25 31 44 55 67  
The example above indicates that NAC 1 has been programmed to Zones 25, 31, 44, 55, and 67 but  
no input devices have been programmed to any of these zones. Use the up and down arrow keys to  
view all the NAC zones without input assignments for NAC1, NAC2, NAC3, and NAC4.  
NOTE: If the NACs have been configured for Class A in the Setup option, only NAC1 and NAC2 will  
display test information. NAC3 and NAC4 will display asterisks (*) and will not be included in the test.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Programming  
Maintenance Programming Level  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Program Check screen will display a screen similar to the following:  
ZONES NO INPUT  
05 07 09 10 11 1M001  
The Zone No Input screen allows the programmer to view the zones which have not been pro-  
grammed to at least one input device (not including general alarm Zone 00). The example in the  
preceding screen indicates that Zones 05, 07, 09, 10, and 11 have been programmed to an address-  
able module (control module in this example) with an address of 001 on loop 1 but have not been  
programmed to any input devices. Use the up and down arrow keys to view all the zones without  
input assignments.  
Pressing 3 while viewing Program Check screen will cause a screen similar to the following to be  
displayed:  
ZONES NO OUTPUT  
05 07 09 10 11 1D001  
The Zone No Output feature allows the programmer to view the zones which have not been pro-  
grammed to at least one output device (not including general alarm Zone 00). The example in the  
preceding screen indicates that Zones 05, 07, 09, 10, and 11 have been programmed to an address-  
able detector with an address of 001 on loop 1 but have not been programmed to any output  
devices. Use the up and down arrow keys to view all the zones without output assignments.  
3.7.4 Walktest  
PROGRAMMING  
1=WALKTEST  
2=SYSTEM  
To perform a walktest, press 1 while viewing Maintenance Screen #2. The following screen will be  
displayed:  
3=ZONE SETUP  
Maintenance Screen #2  
WALKTEST  
1=SILENT  
2=AUDIBLE  
3=VIEW RESULT  
Walktest Screen  
The operator can press 1 to perform a silent walktest or 2 to perform an audible walktest. The dis-  
play will read UNIT IN WALKTEST. To end the Walktest, press the Esc (Escape) key.  
Pressing 3 after the walktest has been completed, will allow the operator to view the results of the  
walktest.  
142  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance Programming Level  
Programming  
3.7.5 System  
To program the time and date into the control panel, press 2 while viewing Maintenance Screen #2.  
The following display will appear:  
SYSTEMS  
1=TIME/DATE  
System Screen  
Pressing 1 while viewing the System Screen will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
TIME AND DATE  
1=TIME 01:00 AM  
2=DATE 01-01-2007  
12HR  
Time and Date Screen  
To change the time, press 1 to display the following screen:  
ENTER TIME  
01:00 AM  
1=AM  
2=PM  
Time Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear on the left side of the display. Enter the four digit number corre-  
sponding to the time (0000 - 1259). When the fourth digit is entered, the cursor will move one  
position to the right. Press 1 for AM or 2 for PM to complete entering the time. The display will  
return to the Time and Date Screen displaying the new time.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Programming  
Maintenance Programming Level  
To change the date, press 2 while viewing the Time and Date Screen. The following screen will be  
displayed:  
ENTER DATE  
MONTH DAY YEAR  
01-01-2010  
Date Screen  
A flashing cursor will appear on the left side of the display. Enter the two digit month, two digit  
day and four digit year. The cursor will move one position to the right after each entry. When the  
fourth digit of the year has been entered, the display will return to the Time and Date Screen which  
will show the new date.  
3.7.6 Zone Setup  
PROGRAMMING  
1=WALKTEST  
2=SYSTEM  
Pressing 3 while viewing Maintenance Screen #2 will display the following screen:  
3=ZONE SETUP  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ENABLE  
2=DISABLE  
Maintenance Screen #2  
3=ZONE 97 98 99  
Zone Setup Screen #1  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONES INSTALLED  
2=ZONES ENABLED  
3=ZONES DISABLED  
Zone Setup Screen #2  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONE TYPES  
2=ZONES AVAILABLE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Zone Setup Screen #3  
144  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintenance Programming Level  
Pressing 1 while viewing Zone Setup screen #1 will display the following screen:  
Programming  
ZONE TO ENABLE  
Z
Enable Screen  
A flashing cursor appears to the right of the Z. To enable a zone, enter the two digit zone number  
(00 - 99). After the second digit is entered, the zone will be enabled and the cursor will return to the  
original position. The next zone to be enabled can then be entered. Press Esc (Escape) to return to  
the previous screen.  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONES INSTALLED  
2=ZONES ENABLED  
3=ZONES DISABLED  
Pressing 2 while viewing Zone Setup screen #1 will display the following screen:  
Zone Setup Screen #2  
ZONE TO DISABLE  
Z
Disable Screen  
A flashing cursor appears to the right of the Z. To disable a zone, enter the two digit zone number  
(00 - 99). After the second digit is entered, the zone will be disabled and the cursor will return to  
the original position. The next zone to be disabled can then be entered. Press Esc (Escape) to  
return to the previous screen.  
Pressing 3 while viewing Zone Setup screen #1 will display the following screen:  
SPEC PURPOSE ZONE  
1=PAS 97  
2=PRE-SIGNAL 98 OFF  
OFF  
3=FUTURE 99  
OFF  
Disable Screen  
Zones 97, 98, and 99 can be programmed for normal zone operation or for special purpose applica-  
tions. In the above illustration, the three zones are shown Off, which means they can be pro-  
grammed to function in the same manner as all other zones, by assigning them to input and output  
devices in the Programming Zone Assignment Screen.  
Pressing 1 will cause the display to change to PAS 97 On. Each press of the 1 key will cause the  
display to toggle between PAS 97 On and PAS 97 Off. When Zone 97 is programmed On, a PAS  
(Positive Alarm Sequence) activation of any detector will cause Zone 97 to activate. By assigning  
Zone 97 to a control module in the Programming Zone Assignment Screen, an output device con-  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming  
Maintenance Programming Level  
nected to the control module can be used to indicate a PAS condition in the control panel. Do not  
assign Zone 97 to a Notification Appliance Circuit when using this zone to indicate a PAS condi-  
tion.  
Pressing 2 will cause the display to change to Pre-signal 98 On. Each press of the 2 key will cause  
the display to toggle between Pre-signal 98 On and Pre-signal 98 Off. When Zone 98 is pro-  
grammed On, a Pre-signal activation of any device will cause Zone 98 to activate. By assigning  
Zone 98 to a control module in the Programming Zone Assignment Screen, an output device con-  
nected to the control module can be used to indicate a Pre-signal condition in the control panel. Do  
not assign Zone 98 to a Notification Appliance Circuit when using this zone to indicate a Pre-signal  
condition.  
Zone 99, in special purpose mode, is reserved for future use and has no effect.  
Zones Installed  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONES INSTALLED  
2=ZONES ENABLED  
3=ZONES DISABLED  
Pressing 1 for Zones Installed, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #2, will display a screen similar to  
the following:  
Zone Setup Screen #2  
ZONES INSTALLED  
00 01 02 03 04 05  
Zones Installed Screen  
This display will show all of the zones that have been programmed into the control panel. Note that  
an up and/or down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that addi-  
tional screens of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view the additional  
zones.  
Zones Enabled  
Pressing 2 for Zones Enabled, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #2, will display a screen similar to  
the following:  
ZONES ENABLED  
00 01 02 04 05 06 07  
08 09 10 11 12 13 14  
15 16 17 18 19 20 21  
Zones Enabled Screen  
This display will show all of the zones that are enabled in the control panel. Note that an up and/or  
down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that additional screens  
of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view the additional zones.  
146  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Maintenance Programming Level  
Programming  
Zones Disabled  
Pressing 3 for Zones Disabled, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #2, will display a screen similar  
to the following:  
ZONES DISABLED  
03  
Zones Disabled Screen  
This display will show all of the zones that are disabled in the control panel. Note that an up and/or  
down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that additional screens  
of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view the additional zones.  
Zone Type  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONE TYPES  
Zone Types must be programmed only if a DACT, programmed for zone reporting, is installed on  
the control panel. Pressing 1 for Zone Types, while viewing Zone Setup Screen #3, will display a  
screen similar to the following:  
2=ZONES AVAILABLE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Zone Setup Screen #3  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=Z00 MONITOR  
2=Z01 MONITOR  
3=Z02 MONITOR  
Zones Installed Screen  
This display will show the system zones (default and user programmed) and their associated types.  
Note that an up and/or down arrow will appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating  
that additional screens of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow keys to view zones  
Z00 through Z99.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Programming  
Maintenance Programming Level  
Zone types can be changed by pressing the keypad number key corresponding to the zone in each  
Zones Installed Screen. Available zone types will be displayed in the resultant screens. For exam-  
ple, to change the zone type for zone Z02 in the screen illustrated above, press 3. The following  
screens will be displayed:  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=HEAT  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=MONITOR  
2=PULL STATION  
3=DUCT  
2=SMOKE PHOTO  
3=WATERFLOW  
Zone Type Program Screen #1  
Zone Type Program Screen #2  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=MEDICAL  
2=HAZARD  
ZONE TYPE PROG  
1=SUPERVISORY  
2=PROC. MON  
3=TAMPER  
3=SMOKE ION  
Zone Type Program Screen #4  
Zone Type Program Screen #3  
To change the zone type for Z02 to Pull Station, scroll the display until Zone Type Program Screen  
#2 is displayed. Press 2 to program zone Z02 as a Pull Station zone. The display will return to the  
Zones Installed Screen showing zone Z02 and the Pull Station program type. Repeat the procedure  
for each zone to be changed.  
IMPORTANT! In Zone Type Program Screen #1, selecting WATERFLOW will assign a Water-  
flow silenceable zone type to the selected zone. Any signaling devices programmed to the same  
zone can be silenced by pressing the Alarm Silence key or by using the auto-silence feature.  
To program a waterflow circuit as nonsilenceable, refer to “System Setup” on page 100.  
NOTE: Zone Types are only relevant for Central Station reporting. Changing a zone type will only  
change how it is reported to the Central Staion.  
Zones Available  
ZONE SETUP  
1=ZONE TYPES  
2=ZONES AVAILABLE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Pressing 2 while viewing Zone Setup Screen #3 will display the following screen:  
Zone Setup Screen #3  
ZONES AVAILABLE  
01 02 03 04 05 06 07  
08 09 10 11 12 13 14  
15 16 17 18 19 20 21  
The display will show all of the zones that are still available for programming. Note that an up  
and/or down arrow may appear in the upper right corner of the display, indicating that additional  
screens of zone information exists. Press the up or down arrow key to view additional screens.  
148  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Maintenance Programming Level  
Programming  
Zone Message  
Pressing 3 while viewing Zone Setup Screen #3 will display the following screen:  
ZONE MESSAGE  
1=Z00  
2=Z01  
3=Z02  
NO MESSAGE  
MESSAGE 1  
NO MESSAGE  
Pressing the down arrow key will display additional screens for Zones up to Z99. Press the number  
key corresponding to the Zone to be programmed. Screens will be displayed allowing the program-  
mer to select Messages 1 through 5. When a message is selected, the display will return to the Zone  
Message screen, showing the message selected for that particular zone. In the example above,  
Zone 01 has been programmed for Message 1.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Section 4: Operating Instructions  
4.1 Panel Control Buttons  
4.1.1 Acknowledge/Step  
The first press of the Acknowledge/Step key silences the piezo sounder, changes flashing LEDs to  
steady and also changes the status field on the LCD display from capital letters to small letters.  
When the piezo is silenced, an acknowledge message is sent to the printer and the history file.  
Acknowledge also sends a silence piezo command to the optional annunciators connected to the  
FACP.  
When more than one event exists, the first press of the Acknowledge/Step key functions as  
described in the preceding paragraph. Subsequent pressing of the key steps through each off-nor-  
mal active event, with alarm events having a higher priority than trouble and supervisory events.  
4.1.2 Alarm Silence  
The Alarm Silence key performs the same functions as Acknowledge/Step. In addition, if an alarm  
exists, it turns off all silenceable NACs (Notification Appliance Circuits) and causes the Alarm  
Silenced LED to turn on. It also sends an ‘alarm silenced’ message to the printer, history file and  
optional annunciators. A subsequent new alarm will resound the system NACs. Note that the  
Alarm Silenced LED is turned off by pressing the Reset key, the Drill key or subsequent activation  
of the NACs.  
4.1.3 Drill/Hold 2 Sec  
When the Drill key is held for a minimum of two seconds (time required to prevent accidental acti-  
vations), the FACP turns on all main panel NAC outputs and all silenceable circuits such as control  
modules that are programmed as silenceable, and turns off the Alarm Silenced LED if it was previ-  
ously on. The EVAC IN SYSTEM message is shown on the LCD display. The same message is sent  
to the printer and history file. The Alarm Silence key can be used to turn off all silenceable NAC  
outputs following activation by the Drill key.  
4.1.4 Reset  
Pressing and releasing the Reset key turns off all control modules and NACs, temporarily turns off  
resettable power to 4-wire detectors, causes a RESET IN SYSTEM message to be displayed on the  
LCD and sends the same message to the printer and history file. It also performs a lamp test by  
turning on all LEDs (except the Ground LED), piezo sounder and LCD display segments after the  
Reset key is released. Any alarm or trouble that exists after a reset will resound the system.  
4.2 LED Indicators  
The nine LED indicators, which are located on the front panel, operate as follows:  
AC Power  
This is a green LED which illuminates if AC power is applied to the FACP. A loss of AC power  
will turn off this LED  
Fire Alarm  
This red LED flashes when one or more alarms occur. It illuminates steady when the Acknowl-  
edge/Step or Alarm Silence key is pressed. The Fire Alarm LED turns off when the Reset key is  
pressed. The LED will remain off if all alarms have been cleared.  
150  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
Normal Operation  
Operating Instructions  
Supervisory  
This is a yellow LED that flashes when one or more supervisory conditions occur, such as a sprin-  
kler valve tamper condition. It illuminates steady when the Acknowledge/Step or Alarm Silence  
key is pressed. It turns off when the Reset key is pressed and remains off if all supervisory alarms  
have been cleared.  
Trouble  
This is a yellow LED that flashes when one or more trouble conditions occur. It stays on steady  
when the Acknowledge/Step or Alarm Silence key is pressed. The LED turns off when all trouble  
conditions are cleared. This LED will also illuminate if the microprocessor watchdog circuit is  
activated.  
Maintenance  
This is a yellow LED that flashes to indicate that a smoke detector requires cleaning or replacement  
due to an invalid chamber reading or excessive drift.  
Alarm Silenced  
This is a yellow LED that turns on after the Alarm Silence key is pressed while an alarm condition  
exists. It turns off when the Drill or Reset key is pressed.  
Disabled  
This is a yellow LED that flashes to indicate that a zone, NAC, detector or module has been tempo-  
rarily disabled in programming by the user.  
Battery  
This is a yellow LED that flashes to indicate a low battery voltage condition.  
Ground  
This is a yellow LED that turns on steady to indicate a ground fault condition (zero impedance  
between FACP and ground).  
4.3 Normal Operation  
With no alarms or troubles in the system, the display message is System All Normal along with the  
current time and date as shown below. To set the time and date, refer to the appropriate section in  
this manual.  
HONEYWELL  
LIFE SAFETY  
SYSTEM ALL NORMAL  
10:00A 010810  
The FACP performs the following functions at regular intervals while in Normal mode:  
• Monitors AC input voltage and battery voltage  
• Monitors and reports status of SLC loop(s), option cards and control panel  
• Polls all devices on the SLC loop(s) and flashes each device LED while checking for valid  
replies, alarms, troubles, etc.  
• Refreshes LCD display and updates time  
• Scans control panel keypad for key presses  
• Performs autotest for all SLC devices  
• Tests memory  
• Updates and reads all communications busses (EIA-485, EIA-232, etc.)  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Operating Instructions  
Trouble Operation  
4.4 Trouble Operation  
With no alarms in the system, the detection of a trouble will cause the following:  
The piezo to pulse 1 second On and 1 second Off  
The system Trouble LED to flash one second On and one second Off  
The trouble relay to activate  
TROUBL with device type, noun/adjective, address and trouble description will appear on the  
LCD display  
The same message, along with the time and date, is sent to the history buffer and optional  
printer  
Terminate upload or download communications  
Note that specific troubles will initiate additional actions; for example, loss of AC power will turn  
off the AC Power LED, a ground fault will turn on the Ground LED, etc.  
Addressable Smoke Detectors, Monitor Modules and Control Modules  
For addressable devices connected to the SLC loop, the following is a typical message that could  
appear on the LCD display for a device trouble:  
TROUBL SMOKE (PHOTO)  
<ADJ> <NOUN>  
INVREP  
10:00A 010810 1D001  
The information displayed in the above example provides the following information:  
First line in display:  
– The type of event; in this example TROUBL indicating a device trouble  
– Device type identifier; in this example, SMOKE (PHOTO) indicates a Photoelectric smoke  
detector. Other device type identifiers which can be displayed include SMOKE (ION) for  
Ionization Detector, HEAT for Heat Detector, CONTROL for Control Module and  
MONITOR for Monitor Module, PULL STATION for a manual pull box, etc. Refer to “Edit  
Module Screen for Control Modules” on page 88 for information on additional device types.  
Second line in display:  
– <ADJ>; refers to the user programmed adjective descriptor from library list resident in the  
control panel or custom entry via PC.  
– <NOUN>; refers to the user programmed noun descriptor from library list resident in the  
control panel or custom entry via PC.  
Third line in display: INVREP indicates an invalid reply from the addressable device. Other  
possible troubles include:  
SHORT - indicating a shorted circuit on an addressable device  
OPEN - indicating an open circuit on an addressable device  
DIRTY1 - maintenance alert indicating that a detector is near but below the allowed alarm  
limit and is in need of maintenance before the performance is compromised  
DIRTY2 - maintenance alert indicating that a detector needs immediate maintenance since it  
has been within 80% of its alarm threshold for 24 hours  
INVREP - maintenance alert indicating a hardware problem in the detector  
TEST F - indicating a detector has failed the automatic test operation which functionally  
checks its sensing chamber and electronics  
152  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Alarm Operation  
Operating Instructions  
INV ID - indicating that an incorrect device code (Type ID) has been programmed for an  
installed device (for example, Photo has been programmed but an Ion detector has been  
installed)  
SW TBL - indicating a module has failed the testing of its Class A switching relay  
Fourth line in display:  
– Time; the current time in this example is 10:00A which represents 10:00 AM  
– Date; the current month, day and year in this example is 01 for January, 08 for the 8th day of  
the month, and 10 for the year 2010  
– Device Address; 1D001 in this example 1 represents SLC Loop1, D represents a detector,  
and 001 represents device address 001  
Pressing the Acknowledge/Step or Alarm Silence key will cause the pulsing piezo to silence and the  
system Trouble LED to change from flashing to on steady. This block acknowledgment occurs  
regardless of the number of troubles, alarms and supervisory events active in the system. When the  
Acknowledge/Step key is pressed and at least one new alarm or trouble exists in the system, the  
‘acknowledge’ message is sent to the printer and history file. If the trouble clears, either before or  
after the Acknowledge/Step key is pressed, the ‘clear trouble’ message is sent to the printer and his-  
tory file.  
If all troubles clear and there are no supervisory or fire conditions active in the system, the system  
returns to normal mode operation and the System All Normal message is shown on the LCD display  
and sent to the history and printer files. The auto-restore feature will restore cleared troubles even  
if the troubles were never acknowledged. Note that pressing the Alarm Silence key when only trou-  
bles exist in the system will have the same effect as pressing the Acknowledge/Step key.  
If multiple trouble conditions exist in the system, they will be automatically scrolled on the LCD  
display at a three second rate. If a combination of alarms, troubles and/or supervisory conditions  
simultaneously occur in the system, only the alarms are scrolled on the display.  
4.5 Alarm Operation  
Alarm operation is similar to trouble operation with the following differences:  
The piezo sounder produces a steady output as opposed to a pulsed output  
The Fire Alarm LED flashes 1 second On and 1 second Off  
The LCD displays Alarm along with the device name, type, address, adjective/noun, associated  
zones and time/date  
Alarms latch and are not allowed to clear automatically  
Alarms activate software zones if so programmed  
Timers for Silence Inhibit, Autosilence and Trouble Reminder are started  
Alarms activate the general alarm relay and general alarm zone Z00  
The trouble relay is not activated  
Store event in history buffer  
Terminate upload or download communications  
Alarms must be Acknowledged before the FACP can be reset  
A typical alarm display would be as illustrated below:  
ALARM PULL STATION  
<ADJ> <NOUN>  
Z000  
10:00A 010810 1M001  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating Instructions  
Supervisory Operation  
Note that the device type, which in this example is PULL STATION, can be any other programma-  
ble alarm type.  
The information displayed in the above example provides the following information:  
First line in display:  
– The type of event; in this example ALARM indicating an alarm condition  
– Device type identifier; in this example, PULL STATION indicates a manual pull box. Other  
device type identifiers which can be displayed include SMOKE (ION) for Ionization  
Detector, HEAT for Heat Detector, CONTROL for Control Module and MONITOR for  
Monitor Module, PULL STATION for a manual pull box, etc. Refer to “Edit Detector” on  
for Control Modules” on page 88 for information on additional device types.  
Second line in display:  
– <ADJ>; refers to the user programmed adjective descriptor from library list resident in the  
control panel or custom entry via PC.  
– <NOUN>; refers to the user programmed noun descriptor from library list resident in the  
control panel or custom entry via PC.  
Third line in display: Z000 indicates the zone programmed to this device which, in this  
example, is general alarm Zone 000. Note that a single device can be programmed to five  
different zones but only the first zone will be displayed.  
Fourth line in display:  
– Time; the current time in this example is 10:00A which represents 10:00 AM  
– Date; the current month, day and year in this example is 01 for January, 08 for the 8th day of  
the month, and 10 for the year 2010  
– Device Address; 1M001 in this example 1 represents SLC Loop1, M represents a module,  
and 001 represents device address 001  
4.6 Supervisory Operation  
Supervisory operation is similar to alarm operation but with the following differences:  
The piezo sounder pulses ½ second On and ½ second Off  
The Supervisory LED flashes ½ second On and ½ second Off  
The LCD displays the status label Active Supervisory along with the device name, type,  
address, adjective/noun, associated zones and time/date  
The supervisory relay is activated  
The alarm relay is not activated  
Silenced alarms are not resounded  
Timers are not started  
Store event in history buffer  
Terminate upload or download communications  
Supervisory condition must be Acknowledged before the FACP can be reset  
154  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Process Monitor Operation  
A typical Supervisory event would be displayed as illustrated in the following:  
Operating Instructions  
ACTIVE SUPERVISORY  
<ADJ> <NOUN>  
Z000  
10:00A 010810 1M001  
Note that, like alarms, supervisory signals latch (except when programmed for supervisory autore-  
settable) and can be assigned to software zones. Supervisory alarms do not cause resound as do  
other alarm conditions. Open circuits in supervisory wiring are processed by the control panel the  
same way as other trouble conditions. Refer to “Alarm Operation” on page 153, for a description  
of the information displayed on the control panel LCD.  
4.7 Process Monitor Operation  
Process Monitor operation will initiate the following events:  
The piezo sounder pulses ¼ second On and ¼ second Off  
The LCD displays a process monitor message along with the device name, type, address,  
adjective/noun, associated zones and time/date  
Relays programmed for process monitoring will be activated  
The alarm relay is not activated  
Silenced alarms are not resounded  
Timers are not started  
Store event in history buffer  
Process Monitor condition must be Acknowledged before the FACP can be reset  
Note that, like supervisories, process monitor signals latch (except when programmed for process  
monitor autoresettable) and can be assigned to software zones.  
4.8 Hazard Condition Operation  
Hazard Condition operation will initiate the following events:  
The piezo sounder turns on steady  
The LCD displays a hazard message along with the device name, type, address,  
adjective/noun, associated zones and time/date  
Relays programmed for process monitoring will be activated  
The alarm relay is not activated  
Silenced alarms are not resounded  
Timers are not started  
Store event in history buffer  
Hazard condition must be Acknowledged before the FACP can be reset  
Hazard conditions latch and will therefore clear only when the hazard condition is cleared and the  
panel reset. They can be assigned to software zones.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Operating Instructions  
Medical Alert Condition Operation  
4.9 Medical Alert Condition Operation  
Medical Alert Condition operation will initiate the following events:  
The piezo sounder turns on steady  
The LCD displays a medical alert message along with the device name, type, address,  
adjective/noun, associated zones and time/date  
Relays programmed for medical alert will be activated  
The alarm relay is not activated  
Silenced alarms are not resounded  
Timers are not started  
Store event in history buffer  
Medical Alert condition must be Acknowledged before the FACP can be reset  
Medical alert conditions latch and will therefore clear only when the medical alert condition is  
cleared and the panel reset. They can be assigned to software zones.  
4.10 Programmed Zone Operation  
Each addressable detector and monitor module can be assigned to a maximum of five software  
alarm zones. A general alarm zone Z00 may be listed for output (control) points, but it is not nec-  
essary to list Z00 for input points, since this is the default zone for all alarm input devices. Zone  
Z00 is also activated by supervisory points.  
When an input device alarms and is not disabled, it activates all software zones assigned to it. An  
output device that is not disabled is turned on when any of the software zones to which it is pro-  
grammed become active.  
4.11 Disable/Enable Operation  
Input points which are disabled do not cause an alarm or any zone activation. Disabled output  
points are held in the off state. All disabled points are treated as if they were in trouble, with the  
exception being the status label that will be displayed is DISABL.  
4.12 Waterflow Circuits Operation  
If an alarm exists from a monitor module point that has a waterflow type code and its mapped NAC  
control module outputs are programmed for nonsilenceable operation, the Alarm Silence key will  
not function.  
4.13 Detector Functions  
Maintenance Alert  
Each addressable detector is monitored by the control panel for its maintenance status. If a detector  
is near but below the allowed alarm limit, a ‘maintenance alert’ message will automatically be dis-  
played, signaling that the detector is in need of servicing.  
Automatic Test Operation  
An automatic test of an addressable detector is performed each minute, resulting in a complete SLC  
loop test in approximately 5 hours (if the loop has the maximum number of devices installed). The  
detector’s sensing chamber and electronics are functionally tested for normal, safe operation. A  
trouble message is displayed upon failure of this test. A System Reset will clear this trouble.  
156  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Time Functions: Real-Time Clock  
Type Code Supervision  
Operating Instructions  
The FACP monitors addressable hardware device codes at slow intervals. Mismatch of any type  
code, compared to the system program, will cause a device trouble.  
System Alarm Verification  
The control panel may be programmed to perform alarm verification to help eliminate the nuisance  
of false alarms. Alarm verification applies to smoke detectors only.  
Smoke Detector Data  
Smoke detector data is monitored by the FACP, eliminating the need to test the sensitivity of each  
detector at its location. A printout of each detector’s data can be retrieved from the FACP using an  
optional printer or Windows© HyperTerminal. Detector sensing ability can decrease with age and  
should be monitored as part of a system’s routine maintenance.  
4.14 Time Functions: Real-Time Clock  
The FACP includes a crystal-based clock that provides time of day, date and day of week. Time is  
displayed as 12 or 24 hour time with month/day/year and is stored in RAM. Daylight savings time  
change-over is programmable and automatic. If both AC and battery are lost, the time must be  
reset.  
4.15 NAC Operation  
There are up to four programmable NACs (Notification Appliance Circuits) resident on the FACP  
main circuit board. The NACs may be programmed as silenceable or nonsilenceable and may also  
be programmed for steady or coded operation. Coded operation provides a choice between March  
Time, Temporal, California coding and two-stage operation.  
4.16 Synchronized NAC Operation  
Synchronization is a panel feature that controls the activation of notification appliances in such a  
way that all devices will turn on and off at exactly the same time. This is particularly critical when  
activating strobes which must be synchronized to avoid random activation and a potential hazard or  
confusion. The FACP can be programmed to operate with a variety of manufacturer’s devices.  
Important: When a Notification Appliance Circuit with a mix of audible and visual devices is  
programmed for silenceable and the synchronization feature is selected, only the audible devices  
will be turned off if the Silence key is pressed. The visual devices (strobes, etc.) will continue to  
operate.  
4.17 Coded Operation  
The NAC circuits resident on the control panel main circuit board can be programmed for coded  
operation. The available pulse rates which can be programmed for coded operation are as follows:  
Continuous:  
Steady output with no pulsing  
March Time:  
Temporal Code:  
Pulses at 120 ppm (pulses per minute)  
Pulses at ½ second On, ½ second Off, ½ second On, ½ second Off,  
½ second On, 1½ second Off  
California Code:  
Two-Stage  
10 seconds On, 5 seconds Off  
Pulses at 20 ppm (pulses per minute) for 5 minutes and  
then changes to Temporal  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                       
Operating Instructions  
Presignal  
4.18 Presignal  
Presignal option programs an initiating device to delay the activation of NACs and/or control mod-  
ules while allowing visual verification by a person. Once a detector or monitor module triggers an  
alarm, the onboard piezo sounds immediately, but the NACs are not activated for a user pro-  
grammed time duration of up to three minutes. Note that the alarm relay and communicator will  
respond to the initial alarm immediately. In addition, Zone 98 will activate. This zone can be pro-  
grammed to a control module which may be used to activate a sounder or indicator which the  
installer designates as a Presignal indication. Do not assign Zone 98 to a Notification Appliance  
Circuit when using this zone to indicate a Pre-signal condition.  
After the programmed delay, the NACs will activate if the source of the alarm is not cleared. Note  
that if a second alarm occurs during the programmed time delay, the alarm will be processed imme-  
diately, causing activation of the appropriate output zones. The events which occur upon Presignal  
activation are as follows:  
• onboard piezo sounds immediately  
• control panel LCD display will indicate a presignal event and the active point  
• control points programmed to Zone 98 will activate  
• annunciators (if enabled) will sound the local piezo, and pulse the alarm LED and zone LED  
• outputs (NACs and control modules) of associated zones will be inhibited from activating  
for a user programmed time delay of up to three minutes  
• second alarm occurring anytime during the time delay will cause immediate activation of all  
associated outputs  
Presignal does not affect monitor modules programmed as waterflow, supervisory, process moni-  
toring or remote switches. Presignal operation requires the approval of the local Authority Having  
Jurisdiction.  
4.19 Positive Alarm Sequence  
PAS (Positive Alarm Sequence) option will program a smoke detector to delay panel activation  
(including alarm relay and communicator) for a period of 15 seconds. Zone 97, however, will acti-  
vate immediately and may be used to connect a signaling device to indicate PAS activation. Do not  
assign Zone 97 to a Notification Appliance Circuit when using this zone to indicate a PAS condi-  
tion.  
When a detector triggers an alarm, the onboard piezo sounds immediately, but the NACs are pre-  
vented from activating for 15 seconds. This inhibit time is factory set and cannot be changed.  
Pressing the Alarm Silence or Acknowledge/Step key during the 15 second inhibit time will silence  
the piezo sounder and start a timer which prevents activation of NACs for an additional time dura-  
tion which can be user programmed for up to three minutes. After the programmed delay, the  
NACs will activate if the source of the alarm is not cleared. Note that if a second alarm occurs dur-  
ing either time delay, the alarm will be processed immediately, causing activation of the appropriate  
output zones. The events which occur upon PAS activation are as follows:  
• onboard piezo sounds immediately  
• control panel LCD display will indicate a presignal event and the active point  
• control points programmed to Zone 97 will activate  
• ACS annunciators (if enabled) will pulse the Zone 97 PAS LED immediately upon PAS  
activation. They will sound the local piezo, and pulse the alarm, associated zone and  
detector address point LEDs after 15 seconds of an unacknowledged PAS activation. Note  
that if the Alarm Silence or Acknowledge/Step button is pressed, the annunciators will be  
inhibited from activating for an additional time delay  
• outputs (NACs and control modules) of associated zones will be inhibited from activating  
for a factory set duration of 15 seconds  
158  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Special System Timers  
Operating Instructions  
• pressing the Alarm Silence or Acknowledge/Step key will start a timer which inhibits output  
activation for additional time delay of up to three minutes which is user programmable  
• second alarm occurring anytime during either time delay will cause immediate activation of  
all associated outputs  
PAS operation requires the approval of the local Authority Having Jurisdiction.  
Note that the PAS BYPASS monitor type code, when activated, will inhibit the PAS capability until  
the PAS BYPASS monitor is deactivated. While PAS is inhibited, signaling devices will immedi-  
ately place the control panel into alarm. This feature may be employed by wiring a normally open  
device, such as a switch, to a monitor module which has been programmed for PAS BYPASS.  
4.20 Special System Timers  
4.20.1 Silence Inhibit Timer  
This option, if selected, prevents the Alarm Silence and Reset keys from functioning for 60 seconds  
following an alarm. A second alarm during this 60 second period will not cause the timer to restart  
with a new 60 seconds. Silence Inhibit operation requires the approval of the local Authority Hav-  
ing Jurisdiction.  
4.20.2 Autosilence Timer  
If Autosilence is selected, the notification appliances, programmed as silenceable, will automati-  
cally be silenced after a programmable duration of from 5 to 30 minutes. Pressing the Drill key  
will restart the timer. Autosilence operation requires the approval of the local Authority Having  
Jurisdiction.  
4.20.3 Trouble Reminder  
If selected, this feature causes a reminding ‘beep’ every 15 seconds during an alarm (after the  
Alarm Silence key is pressed) and every two minutes during a trouble condition (after the Acknowl-  
edge/Step or Alarm Silence key is pressed). The ‘beeps’ from the onboard piezo sounder will occur  
until the alarm or fault is cleared.  
Note that if the trouble is not cleared within 24 hours, the piezo will resound, indicating that the  
trouble condition still exists.  
4.20.4 Waterflow Retard Timer  
If selected, this option will delay the activation of a waterflow type alarm for a programmable time  
duration from 1 to 90 seconds. This delay is in addition to any time delay inherent in the waterflow  
device. This feature requires the approval of the local Authority Having Jurisdiction.  
4.20.5 Alarm Verification  
If alarm verification is selected, an addressable smoke detector's alarm is ignored for a Retard time  
of 13 seconds and the detector’s alarm condition is automatically reset. There will be no alarm  
indication at the FACP during the Retard period. A Confirmation period of 60 seconds follows,  
during which a subsequent alarm from the same detector will cause the panel to immediately acti-  
vate the appropriate outputs and indicate the alarm condition at the FACP. If a different detector  
alarms any time during the first detector's verification period, the panel will immediately activate  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Operating Instructions  
Walktest  
all appropriate outputs and indicate the alarm condition at the FACP. If no additional detector  
alarms occur within 73 seconds of the first alarm (13 second Retard plus 60 second Confirmation),  
the timer resets and the panel is ready to verify any new detector alarms which may occur.  
13 sec.  
73 sec.  
0 sec.  
RETARD  
Detector Alarm  
CONFIRMATION (60 seconds)  
Verification (Retard +  
Confirmation)  
Alarm Ignored  
Control Panel Processes Alarm if Same Detector is Still in Alarm  
Detector Goes Into Alarm  
Control Panel Immediately Processes Alarm  
Different Detector Alarms  
During First Detector's  
Verification Period  
NOTE: Alarm Verification is available only for addressable smoke detectors, not conventional  
smoke detectors.  
4.21 Walktest  
Walktest is a feature which allows one person to test the fire alarm system. An audible walktest  
will momentarily sound the Notification Appliance Circuits in the building and store the walktest  
information in a file at the panel. A silent walktest will not sound the NACs but will store the walk-  
test information in a file which can be viewed at the panel. Disabled NAC devices will not activate  
during walktest.  
Alarm/Shorted Condition  
When in audible Walktest, the panel responds to each new alarm and activates its programmed con-  
trol outputs for four seconds, if those outputs have been programmed for silenceable activation. It  
also stores each alarm in the walktest history file which can be sent to an optional printer. The  
stored display will be the same as if the device actually activated except the colon (:) in the time  
stamp is replaced with an asterisk (*).  
Open Condition  
Addressable devices are monitored for fault conditions during Walktest mode. When a new trouble  
condition occurs, the FACP will activate all NACs and control modules programmed for Walktest  
and mapped to the faulted device, then shut them off after eight seconds.  
While in Walktest, the trouble relay is activated and the system Trouble LED flashes (as in all of  
the Program and status change operations). The alarm relay is not activated.  
4.22 Read Status  
Read Status functions do not require a password. The control panel will continue to provide fire  
protection while in Read Status mode. This mode can be entered while the control panel is in alarm  
or trouble. If a new alarm or trouble occurs during these functions, the Read Status is exited to pre-  
vent confusion.  
160  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
Read Status Entry  
When the operator presses the control panel Enter key, the LCD will display the following:  
1=READ STATUS  
2=PROGRAMMING  
3=REMOTE  
DOWNLOAD  
Pressing 1, while this screen is being displayed, will cause the control panel to enter the Read Sta-  
tus mode which allows the user to view and print the programmed features and status of the control  
panel.  
The following screens will be displayed:  
READ STATUS  
1=TROUBLE REMINDER  
2=TIMERS  
READ STATUS  
1=SYSTEM POINT  
2=ZONES  
3=POWER  
3=NACS  
Read Status Screen #1  
Read Status Screen #2  
READ STATUS  
1=RELAYS  
2=PROGRAM CHECK  
3=HISTORY  
READ STATUS  
1=ANNUNCIATORS  
2=PHONE LINE  
3=CENTRAL STATION  
Read Status Screen #3  
Read Status Screen #4  
READ STATUS  
1=SERVICE TERMINAL  
2=PRINTER/PC  
3=PRINT  
READ STATUS  
1=TIME-DATE  
Read Status Screen #5  
Read Status Screen #6  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operating Instructions  
Read Status  
4.22.1 System Point  
READ STATUS  
1=SYSTEM POINT  
2=ZONES  
Pressing 1 while viewing Read Status Screen #1 will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
3=POWER  
READ SYSTEM POINT  
SELECT LOOP  
1=LOOP 1  
Read Status Screen #1  
2=LOOP 2  
The operator selects the loop containing the device to be read by pressing 1 for Loop 1 or 2 for  
Loop 2. The following screen will then be displayed:  
READ SYSTEM POINT  
SELECT TYPE  
1=DETECTOR  
2=MODULE  
The operator now selects the type of device which is to be viewed by pressing 1 for Detector or 2  
for Module. If 1 is pressed, the display will change to the following screen:  
READ SYSTEM POINT  
ENTER DETECTOR#  
***  
Entering the three digit detector address will cause the control panel to display the current status of  
the selected device. For example, if a detector with address 001 on loop 1 is entered, a display sim-  
ilar to the following will appear:  
NORMAL SMOKE(PHOTO)  
NORTH CLASSROOM  
Z005  
1D001  
The information in the preceding display includes:  
NORMAL - the present status (could also be ALARM, TROUBL, DISABL, etc.)  
SMOKE (PHOTO) - the device type which is a photoelectric smoke detector (could also be  
ION for ionization smoke detector)  
NORTH CLASSROOM - the Adjective/Noun label for this device  
Z005 - the first of five possible assigned software zones  
1D001 - 1 = Loop 1, D = Detector, 001 = Address 001  
162  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
Pressing the down arrow key, while viewing the screen shown on the previous page, will allow the  
operator to view additional programming information about the selected device, such as:  
Enable/Disable Status  
Device Type  
Alarm Verification On/Off  
Walktest Yes/No  
PAS (Positive Alarm Sequence) Yes/No  
Pre-Signal Yes/No  
Zone Assignments (five maximum)  
Chamber Reading  
Adjective/Noun descriptor  
Silenceable Yes/No (for control modules)  
4.22.2 Zones  
Pressing 2 while viewing Read Status Screen #1 will cause the following screens to be displayed:  
READ STATUS  
1=SYSTEM POINT  
2=ZONES  
ZONES  
3=POWER  
1=ZONES INSTALLED  
2=ZONES ENABLED  
3=ZONES DISABLED  
Read Status Screen #1  
Zones Screen #1  
ZONES  
1=SPECIAL PURPOSE  
2=ZONE TYPE  
3=ZONE MESSAGE  
Zones Screen #2  
From the preceding screens, the control panel operator can view:  
Zones Installed - all software zones programmed into the system (99 maximum)  
Zones Enabled - all software zones that are enabled  
Zones Disabled - all software zones that have been disabled  
Special Purpose - on or off programming for Special Purpose Zones 97 reserved for PAS, 98  
reserved for Pre-signal and 99 reserved for future use  
Zone Type - the Type assigned to each installed zone (default is Alarm)  
Zone Message - the message assigned to each installed zone  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operating Instructions  
Read Status  
4.22.3 Power  
Pressing 3 while viewing Read Status Screen #1 will display the following screens:  
POWER  
BATTERY  
24 V RST  
27.21V  
25.31V  
Zones Screen #1  
POWER  
CHARGER  
NAC 1  
NAC 2  
28.36V  
-2.39V  
-2.39V  
Zones Screen #2  
POWER  
NAC 3  
NAC 4  
-2.39V  
-2.39V  
Zones Screen #3  
A real-time display of control panel voltages can be used to determine if system problems exist.  
Note that Zones Screen #3 will only be displayed if the NACKEY NAC option card is installed, in  
JP8 of the main circuit board, for Class B operation.  
The following table lists the circuit being measured, possible conditions and their respective volt-  
age ranges:  
Circuit  
Condition  
Normal Battery (nominal)  
Low Battery  
No Battery  
Normal  
Voltage Range  
27.05 to 28.15 VDC  
20.0 to 20.8 VDC  
0 to 18.36 VDC  
Battery  
24V Resettable  
24V Nonresettable  
Charger  
21.25 to 27.50 VDC  
21.25 to 27.50 VDC  
27.05 to 28.15 VDC  
-1.3 to -1.6 VDC  
-2.3 to -2.5 VDC  
0 to 1.0 VDC  
Normal  
Normal  
Normal  
NACs  
Open Circuit  
Short Circuit  
164  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
4.22.4 Trouble Reminder  
Pressing 1 while viewing Read Status Screen #2 will display the following screen:  
READ STATUS  
1=TROUBLE REMINDER  
2=TIMERS  
TROUBLE REMINDER  
TROUBLE REM  
3=NACS  
ON  
Read Status Screen #2  
The screen indicates whether the Trouble Reminder feature is On or Off.  
4.22.5 Timers  
Pressing 2 while viewing Read Status Screen #2 will cause the following Timer screens to be dis-  
played:  
TIMERS  
PAS DELAY  
PRE SIGNAL  
WATERFLOW  
000  
000  
000  
TIMERS  
AC LOSS DELAY  
4
These screens indicate the delay time, in seconds, for each of four possible delay options.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Operating Instructions  
Read Status  
4.22.6 NAC  
Pressing 3 while viewing Read Status Screen #2 will display the following screen:  
NAC  
1=NAC 1  
2=NAC 2  
3=NAC 3  
4=NAC 4  
Note that 3=NAC 3 and 4=NAC 4 will only be displayed if the NACKEY NAC option card is  
installed, in JP8 of the main circuit board, for Class B operation.  
The operator can press 1 to view the programmed options for NAC 1, 2 to view the programmed  
options for NAC 2, 3 to view the programmed options for NAC 3, or 4 to view the programmed  
options for NAC 4. The resulting screens will display the following information:  
Enable/Disable Status  
Circuit Type (Bell, Strobe, etc.)  
Silenceable/Nonsilenceable  
Auto Silence Enable/Disable and time delay  
Coding Selection (Temporal, Steady, etc.)  
Zone Assignments  
Silence Inhibit Enabled/Disabled  
Synchronization Type (System Sensor, Wheelock or Gentex)  
4.22.7 Relays  
READ STATUS  
1=RELAYS  
Pressing 1 while viewing Read Status Screen #3 will display the following screen:  
2=PROGRAM CHECK  
3=HISTORY  
Read Status Screen #3  
RELAYS  
1=RELAY 1  
2=RELAY 2  
3=RELAY 3  
The operator can view the programmed option for each relay by pressing the corresponding number  
key.  
166  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
4.22.8 Program Check  
Pressing 2 while viewing Read Status Screen #3 will cause a screen similar to the following to be  
displayed:  
PROGRAM CHECK  
1=NACS NO INPUT  
2=ZONES NO INPUT  
3=ZONES NO OUTPUT  
Pressing 1 while viewing the Program Check screen will display a screen which will indicate if any  
input zones have not been programmed to one of the Notification Appliance Circuits. Use the up  
and down arrow keys to view all NACs.  
Pressing 2 while viewing the Program Check screen will display a screen which will indicate if any  
output zones have not been programmed to at least one input zone. Use the up and down arrow  
keys to view all zones.  
Pressing 3 while viewing the Program Check screen will display a screen which will indicate if any  
input zones have not been programmed to at least one output zone. Use the up and down arrow  
keys to view all zones.  
4.22.9 History  
Pressing 3 while viewing Read Status Screen #3 will display the following screen:  
HISTORY  
1=VIEW ALL  
2=VIEW ALARMS  
3=VIEW OTHER EVENTS  
The operator can view all events which have been stored in the history file, only alarms or other  
events, such as troubles or supervisories, by pressing the corresponding number key.  
4.22.10 Annunciators  
Pressing 1 while viewing Read Status Screen #4 will display the following screens:  
READ STATUS  
1=ANNUNCIATORS  
2=PHONE LINES  
ANNUNCIATORS  
TERM ENABLED  
2=ACS OPTIONS  
3=ANN-BUS OPTIONS  
YES  
3=CENTRAL STATION  
Read Status Screen #4  
Annunciator Screen  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Operating Instructions  
The Annunciator Screen indicates if Terminal mode options are enabled or disabled.  
Read Status  
Pressing 2 for ACS Options while viewing the Annunciator Screen allows the operator to view the  
ACS Options screen:  
ACS OPTIONS  
ACS ENABLED  
NO  
2=ACS ADDRESSES  
UDACT ENABLED NO  
ACS Options Screen  
The ACS Options screen indicates if the ACS option has been enabled YES or disabled NO.  
Pressing 2 for ACS Addresses while viewing the ACS Options screen will display screens with  
ACS addresses 1 -31 and whether a device is installed at that address YES or not installed NO.  
The ACS Options screen indicates if a UDACT is installed YES or if a UDACT is not installed NO.  
Pressing 3 for ANN-BUS Options while viewing the Annunciator Screen will display the following  
screens:  
ANN-BUS  
ENABLED  
NO  
2=MODULES INSTALLED  
3=ANN-S/PG OPTIONS  
ANN-BUS Screen #1  
ANN-BUS  
1=ANN-80 OPTIONS  
ANN-BUS Screen #2  
The ANN-BUS Screen #1 indicates if the ANN-BUS has been enabled YES or disabled NO.  
Pressing 2 for Modules Installed while viewing ANN-BUS Screen #1 will display screens for  
ANN-BUS Addresses 1 -8 and the devices installed at each address. Subscreen will display the  
options that have been programmed for each device.  
Pressing 3 for ANN-S/PG Options while viewing ANN-BUS Screen #1 will display the options  
selected for the installed serial or parallel printer.  
Pressing 1 for ANN-80 Options while viewing ANN-BUS Screen #2 will display the options  
selected for the installed ANN-80 annunciators.  
168  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
4.22.11 Phone Line  
Pressing 2 while viewing Read Status Screen #4 will display the following screen:  
PHONE LINE  
PRIMARY TOUCHTONE  
SECONDARY TOUCHTONE  
3=SUPERV PHONE LINE  
The second and third lines of this screen indicate that both the Primary and Secondary phone lines  
have been configured for touchtone dialing operation.  
Pressing 3 while viewing the Phone Line screen will cause the following screen to be displayed:  
SUPERVISE PHONE LINE  
PHONE LINE 2  
NO  
This screen indicates whether or not Phone Line 2 is being supervised. In this example, PHONE  
LINE 2 NO indicates the phone line is not being supervised.  
4.22.12 Central Station  
READ STATUS  
1=ANNUNCIATORS  
2=PHONE LINE  
Pressing 3 while viewing Read Status Screen #4 will display the following screens:  
3=CENTRAL STATION  
CENTRAL STATION  
Read Status Screen #4  
REPORTING  
REPORT FIRST AVAIL  
CALL LIMIT 10  
ENABLED  
Central Station Screen #1  
CENTRAL STATION  
1=PRIMARY  
2=SECONDARY  
REPORT STYLE  
ZONE  
Central Station Screen #2  
Central Station Screen #1 indicates whether the Central Station Reporting is enabled or disabled, if  
the Reports will be sent to the First Available or Backup Primary and Secondary Central Station  
phone numbers and Call Limit for DACT trouble calls within a 24 hour period. Central Station  
Screen #2 provides information on the Report Style (Zone or Point) as well as the Primary and Sec-  
ondary Central Station programming which includes:  
Test Time Interval  
Account Code  
24 Hour Test Time  
Phone Number  
Communication Format  
Event Codes  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Operating Instructions  
Read Status  
4.22.13 Service Terminal  
Pressing 1 while viewing Read Status Screen #5 will display the following screens:  
READ STATUS  
1=SERVICE TERMINAL  
2=PRINTER/PC  
3=PRINT  
SERVICE TERMINAL  
RING COUNT  
05  
Read Status Screen #5  
Service Terminal Screen  
The Ring Count is displayed in the Service Terminal Screen. A Ring Count value of 00 would indi-  
cate that calling is disabled.  
4.22.14 Printer/PC  
Pressing 2 while viewing Read Status Screen #5 will display the following screen:  
PRINTER PC  
PRINTER PC PR4800  
Printer/PC Screen  
The display will inform the operator as to whether the control panel is configured for a printer or a  
PC and if the printer is supervised. In the example above, PR4800 indicates that the panel is con-  
figured for a printer with a baud rate of 4800 and PR indicates that the printer is being supervised.  
If NS appeared in place of PR, it would indicate that the printer is not supervised.  
170  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
4.22.15 Print  
To print program data or control panel status, press 3 while viewing Read Status Screen #5. The  
following screens will be displayed:  
READ STATUS  
1=SERVICE TERMINAL  
2=PRINTER/PC  
3=PRINT  
PRINT  
1=HISTORY  
2=WALKTEST LOG  
3=DETECTOR DATA  
Read Status Screen #5  
Print Screen #1  
PRINT  
1=EXIT PRINTING  
Print Screen #2  
Pressing 1 while viewing Print Screen #1 allows the user to print the History file which will detail  
all of the system activities since the file was last cleared from memory.  
Pressing 2 while viewing Print Screen #1 allows the user to print the Walktest log which will detail  
all of the system activations during walktest since the log was last cleared. Refer to “Walktest” on  
page 160 for additional information on the display.  
Pressing 3 while viewing Print Screen #1 allows the user to print the detector data for each address-  
able smoke detector connected to the system. A printout, similar to the following example, will be  
generated if an optional printer is connected to the FACP.  
DEVICE #  
DEVICE TYPE  
%DRIFT COMP  
CHAMBER  
1281  
TIME/DATE  
1D001  
1D002  
1D003  
1D004  
1D005  
1D006  
1D007  
1D008  
1D009  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
SMOKE (PHOTO)  
20  
20  
21  
20  
21  
20  
20  
20  
20  
12:01AM 01-08-2001  
12:01AM 01-08-2001  
12:01AM 01-08-2001  
12:02AM 01-08-2001  
12:02AM 01-08-2001  
12:02AM 01-08-2001  
12:02AM 01-08-2001  
12:02AM 01-08-2001  
12:02AM 01-08-2001  
1281  
1259  
1309  
1281  
1322  
1280  
1215  
1310  
Chamber Value  
The Chamber value should be within the indicated range for the following smoke detectors:  
SD350(T), SD355(T), D350P(R), SD300(T), AD350 and AD355 Addressable Photoelectric  
Smoke Detectors: 405 - 2100 (obscuration of 1.00%/ft to 3.66%/ft.)  
CP350, CP355 and CP300 Addressable Ionization Smoke Detectors: 750 - 2100 (obscuration  
of 0.50%/ft. to 1.44%/ft.)  
If the addressable smoke detector’s Chamber reading is not within the acceptable range, clean the  
detector and check the Chamber value again. If the reading is still not within the acceptable range,  
immediately replace the detector.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Operating Instructions  
Drift Compensation  
Read Status  
Drift compensation uses software algorithms that identify and compensate for long-term changes in  
the data readings from each addressable smoke detector. These long-term changes in detector data  
readings are typically caused by dirt and dust accumulation inside the smoke chamber. Drift com-  
pensation performs the following functions:  
Samples each photoelectric smoke detector every 6 seconds and each ionization smoke  
detector every 3 seconds  
Allows a smoke detector to retain its original ability to detect actual smoke and resist false  
alarms, even as dirt and dust accumulate  
Reduces maintenance requirements by allowing the control panel to automatically perform the  
periodic sensitivity measurements required by NFPA Standard 72  
The FACP software also provides filters to remove transient noise signals, usually caused by elec-  
trical interference.  
Maintenance Alert  
The software determines when the drift compensation for a detector reaches an unacceptable level  
that can compromise detector performance. When a detector reaches an unacceptable level, the  
control panel indicates a maintenance alert. Table 4.1 summarizes the three levels of maintenance  
alert:  
Maintenance Level  
Low Chamber Value  
Maintenance Alert  
FACP Status Displays Indicates  
INVREP  
DIRTY1  
A hardware problem in the detector  
Dust accumulation that is near but below the allowed  
limit. DIRTY 1 indicates the need for maintenance  
before the performance of the detector is compromised  
DIRTY2  
Maintenance Urgent  
Dust accumulation above the allowed limit.  
Table 4.1 Maintenance Alert Levels  
Figure 4.1 illustrates a graphic representation of the maintenance levels:  
DIRTY  
Maintenance  
Urgent  
Maintenance  
Alert  
Acceptable  
Range  
LowChamber  
Reading  
LOW  
VALUE  
Figure 4.1 Diagram of Maintenance Levels  
172  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Read Status  
Operating Instructions  
4.22.16 Time-Date  
The operator can view the daylight savings time and the month and week when daylight savings  
time will begin and end. Pressing 1 while viewing Read Status Screen #6 will display the following  
screens:  
READ STATUS  
1=TIME-DATE  
Read Status Screen #6  
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS  
ENABLED  
YES  
MAR  
START WEEK WEEK-2  
START MONTH  
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS  
END MONTH  
END WEEK  
NOV  
WEEK-1  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Section 5: Power Supply Calculations  
5.1 Overview  
This section contains instructions and tables for calculating power supply currents in alarm and  
standby conditions. This is a four-step process, consisting of the following:  
1. Calculating the total amount of AC branch circuit current required to operate the system  
2. Calculating the power supply load current for non-fire and fire alarm conditions and  
calculating the secondary (battery) load  
3. Calculating the size of batteries required to support the system if an AC power loss occurs  
4. Selecting the proper batteries for your system  
5.2 Calculating the AC Branch Circuit  
The control panel requires connection to a separate, dedicated AC branch circuit, which must be  
labeled FIRE ALARM. This branch circuit must connect to the line side of the main power feed  
of the protected premises. No other non-fire alarm equipment may be powered from the fire alarm  
branch circuit. The branch circuit wire must run continuously, without any disconnect devices,  
from the power source to the control panel. Overcurrent protection for this circuit must comply  
with Article 760 of the National Electrical Codes as well as local codes. Use 14 AWG (2.00 mm2)  
wire with 600 volt insulation for this branch circuit.  
Use Table 5.1, to determine the total amount of current, in AC amperes (A), that must be supplied  
to the system.  
Device Type  
Number of  
Devices  
Current Draw  
(AC amps)  
Total Current per  
Device  
MS-9600LS(C)  
MS-9600UDLS  
or  
3.0  
or  
1
X
=
MS-9600LSE  
MS-9600UDLSE  
1.5  
2.0  
CHG-120F  
[
[
]
]
X
X
=
=
=
[
]
Sum Column for AC Branch Current Required  
Table 5.1 AC Branch Circuit Requirements  
5.3 Calculating the System Current Draw  
5.3.1 Overview  
The control panel must be able to power all internal and external devices continuously during the  
non-fire alarm condition. To calculate the non-fire alarm load on the system power supply when  
primary power is applied, use Calculation Column 1 in Table 5.3 on page 176. The control panel  
must support a larger load current during a fire alarm condition. To calculate the fire alarm load on  
the power supply, use Calculation Column 2 in Table 5.3 on page 176. The secondary power  
source (batteries) must be able to power the system during a primary power loss. To calculate the  
non-fire alarm load on the secondary power source, use Calculation Column 3 in Table 5.3 on  
page 176.  
When calculating current draw and the battery size, note the following:  
‘Primary’ refers to the main power source for the control panel  
174  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Calculating the System Current Draw  
Power Supply Calculations  
‘Secondary’ refers to the control panel’s backup batteries  
All currents are given in amperes (A). Table 5.2 shows how to convert milliamperes and  
microamperes to full amperes.  
To convert...  
Multiply  
Example  
Milliamperes (mA) to  
amperes (A)  
mA x 0.001  
3 mA x 0.001 = 0.003A  
Microamperes (µA) to  
amperes (A)  
µA x 0.000001  
300 µA x 0.000001 = 0.0003 A  
Table 5.2 Converting to Full Amperes  
5.3.2 How to Use Table 5.3 on page 176 to Calculate System  
Current Draw  
Use Table 5.3 on page 176 to calculate current draws as follows:  
1. Enter the quantity of devices in all three columns.  
2. Enter the current draw where required. Refer to the Device Compatibility Document for  
compatible devices and their current draw.  
3. Calculate the current draws for each in all columns.  
4. Sum the total current for each column.  
5. Copy the totals from Column 2 and Column 3 to Table 5.4 on page 177.  
Following are the types of current that can be entered into Table 5.3 on page 176:  
Calculation Column 1 - The primary supply current load that the control panel must  
support during a non-fire alarm condition, with AC power applied.  
Calculation Column 2 - The primary supply current load that the control panel must  
support during a fire alarm condition, with AC power applied.  
Calculation Column 3 - The standby current drawn from the batteries in a non-fire alarm  
condition during a loss of AC power.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Power Supply Calculations  
Calculating the System Current Draw  
Table 5.3 contains columns for calculating current draws. For each column, calculate the current  
and enter the total (in amperes) in the bottom row. When finished, copy the totals from Calculation  
Column 2 and Calculation Column 3 to Table 5.4 on page 177.  
Calculation Column 1  
Calculation Column 2  
Calculation Column 3  
Primary, Non-Fire Alarm Current (amps) Primary, Fire Alarm Current (amps)  
Secondary, Non-Fire Alarm Current (amps)  
Device Type  
Qty  
X[current draw]=  
Total  
Qty  
X [current draw] =  
Total  
Qty  
X[current draw]=  
Total  
Main Circuit Board  
ANN-80  
1
X[0.160]=  
X[0.037]=  
X[0.028]=  
X[0.015]=  
X[0.035]=  
X[0.045]=  
X[0.030]=  
X[0.040]  
0.160  
1
X[0.253]=  
X[0.040]=  
X[0.068]=  
X[0.075]=  
X[0.200]=  
X[0.045]=  
0.253  
1
X[0.103]=  
X[0.015]=  
X[0.028]=  
X[0.015]=  
X[0.035]=  
X[0.045]=  
X[0.030]=  
X[0.040]=  
0.103  
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
ANN-(R)LED  
ANN-RLY  
ANN-I/O  
ANN-S/PG  
ACM-8RF  
1
X[0.158] =  
2
ACM-16ATF  
ACM-32AF  
X[0.056] =  
2
AEM-16ATF  
AEM-32AF  
[
[
]
]
X[0.002]  
X[0.040]  
[
[
]
]
X[0.018] =  
[
[
]
]
X[0.002]=  
X[0.040]=  
2
AFM-16ATF  
AFM-32AF  
X[0.056] =  
2
AFM-16AF  
DACT-UD2  
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
X[0.025]  
X[0.020]  
X[0.040]  
X[0.002]  
X[0.064]  
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
X[0.065] =  
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
]
X[0.025]=  
X[0.017]=  
X[0.040]=  
X[0.002]=  
X[0.025]=  
X[0.005]=  
X[0.029]=  
3
LDM-32F  
X[0.056] =  
LDM-E32F  
X[0.018]=  
X[0.064]=  
LCD-80F & LCD-80FC  
4XTMF  
4
X[0.005]=  
5
X[0.011] =  
4-wire Detector Heads  
Power Supervision Relays  
SLC-2LS Expander  
CP350 & CP355  
SD350 & SD355  
SD350T & SD355T  
AD350 & AD355  
H350 & H355  
X[  
] =  
X[  
]=  
X[  
]=  
6
X[0.025]=  
X[0.02500]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.001]=  
X[0.025]=  
X[0.025]=  
X[0.01900]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.001]=  
X[0.02600]=  
H350R & H355R  
H355HT  
D350P & D350PL  
D350RP & D350RPL  
7
B501BH & B501BHT  
maximum alarm draw  
for all devices:  
B224RB Relay Base  
B224BI Isolator Base  
MMF-300  
X[0.00050]=  
X[0.00045]=  
X[0.00040]=  
X[0.00350]=  
X[0.00075]=  
X[0.000375]=  
X[0.00027]=  
X[0.00200]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00039]=  
X[0.00225]=  
X[0.00027]=  
X[0.00145]=  
X[0.00040]=  
X[0.00050]=  
X[0.00045]=  
X[0.00040]=  
X[0.00350]=  
X[0.00075]=  
X[0.000375]=  
X[0.00027]=  
X[0.00200]=  
X[0.00030]=  
X[0.00039]=  
X[0.00225]=  
X[0.00027]=  
X[0.00145]=  
X[0.00040]=  
with one (1) SLC Loop  
with two (2) SLC Loops  
0.400  
0.800  
MMF-300-10  
MDF-300  
MMF-301  
MMF-302  
MMF-302-6  
BG-12LX  
CMF-300  
CMF-300-6  
CRF-300  
CRF-300-6  
I300  
8
NAC #1  
[
[
[
[
[
]
]
]
]
]
X[  
X[  
X[  
X[  
[
]=  
]=  
]=  
]=  
NAC #2  
NAC #3  
NAC #4  
Current Draw from TB3  
[
]=  
]=  
[
]
[
]=  
9
(nonalarm )  
10  
Sum each column for  
totals  
Primary Non-Alarm =  
Primary Alarm =  
Secondary Non-Alarm =  
Table 5.3 System Current Draw Calculations  
1 All eight ACM-8RF relays activated on a single module.  
2 All annunciator LEDs on  
3 LDM-32F with LEDs on  
4 If using the Reverse Polarity Alarm output, add 0.005 amps; if using the Reverse Polarity Trouble output, add  
another 0.005 amps.  
5 Refer to the Device Compatibility Document for standby current.  
6 Must use compatible listed Power Supervision Relay.  
7 Maximum alarm current for each sounder base is 0.015 amps which must be supplied by aux. 24VDC source.  
8 Current limitation of Terminal TB4 circuits is 3.00 amps per NAC.  
9 The total standby current must include both the resettable (TB3 Terminals 1 & 2) and nonresettable (TB3 Terminals  
3 & 4, 5 & 6) power. Caution must be taken to ensure that current drawn from these outputs during alarm does not  
exceed maximum ratings specified. Current limitations of TB3 circuits is 3.0 amps per output  
10 Total current draw listed above cannot exceed 7.0 amps in alarm.  
176  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Calculating the Battery Size  
Power Supply Calculations  
5.4 Calculating the Battery Size  
Use Table 5.4 to calculate the total Standby and Alarm load in ampere hours (AH). This total load  
determines the battery size (in AH), required to support the control panel under the loss of AC  
power. Complete Table 5.4 as follows:  
1. Enter the totals from Table 5.3 on page 176, Calculation Columns 2 and 3 where shown.  
2. Enter the NFPA Standby and Alarm times (refer to ‘NFPA Requirements’ below).  
3. Calculate the ampere hours for Standby and Alarm, then sum the Standby and Alarm ampere  
hours.  
4. Multiply the sum by the derating factor of 1.2 to calculate the proper battery size (in AH).  
5. Write the ampere hour requirements on the Protected Premises label located inside the cabinet  
door.  
Secondary Standby Load  
(total from Table 5.3 Calculation  
Column 3)  
Required Standby Time  
(24 hours)  
[
]
X[  
]
=
AH  
Primary Alarm Load  
(total from Table 5.3 Calculation  
Column 2)  
Required Alarm Time  
(for 5 min., enter 0.084,  
for 10 min., enter 0.168)  
[
]
X[  
]
=
=
X
=
AH  
AH  
Sum of Standby and Alarm Ampere Hours  
Multiply by the Derating Factor  
1.2  
Battery Size, Total Ampere Hours Required  
AH  
Table 5.4 Total Secondary Power Requirements at 24 VDC  
5.4.1 NFPA Battery Requirements  
NFPA 72 Local, Proprietary, Central, Auxiliary and Remote Station Fire Alarm Systems  
require 24 hours of standby power followed by 5 minutes in alarm  
NFPA requires 24 hours of standby plus 15 minutes activation for audio systems. The total  
ampere hours required cannot exceed 26 AH with an internal charger  
5.4.2 Selecting and Locating Batteries  
Select sealed lead acid batteries that meet or exceed the total ampere hours calculated in Table 5.4.  
The control panel can charge batteries in the 12 AH to 26 AH range. The control panel cabinet is  
capable of housing batteries up to 18 AH. Batteries larger than 18 AH require the BB-26, BB-55F,  
or other UL-listed external battery cabinet.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Appendix A: Software Zones  
A.1 Correlations  
Setup and configuration of an addressable system is different than a conventional system. In a  
conventional system, assignment of input devices (smoke detectors, pull stations, heat detectors,  
etc.) to zones is accomplished through wiring. The wiring is direct from clearly marked panel  
terminals to any device assigned to a particular zone. Connection of output devices (horns, bells,  
strobes, etc.) in a conventional system is accomplished by direct wiring of the output devices to  
Notification Appliance Circuit terminals.  
In an addressable system, a minimum of a single pair of wires (SLC communication loop) is used  
to connect all addressable input and output devices. Communications between the FACP (Fire  
Alarm Control Panel) and all addressable devices takes place over the wire pair which originates  
from the FACP. Software programming is used to configure the system as opposed to direct wiring.  
Zone assignments are created via software means, hence the term software zones.  
Setup of an FACP software zone is accomplished by panel programming. Each addressable device  
can be assigned to a maximum of five software zones. Each software zone, however, may have  
1
from 1 to 99 addressable input devices assigned to it and from 1 to 99 addressable output devices  
assigned to it.  
Monitor and control modules comprise one group of 99 addresses, with each module having a  
unique address from 1 to 99 . Detectors comprise a separate group of 99 addresses, each detector  
having a unique address from 1 to 99 in its group. Be careful not to duplicate addresses within any  
one group (modules and detectors). Refer to the following page for an example of zoning.  
In the example on the following page:  
Zone 01 has the following addressable devices assigned to it:  
• SD350 smoke detectors with addresses 01 and 02  
• MMF-300 monitor module with address 01  
• MMF-302 monitor module with address 02 and 03  
• CMF-300 control modules with addresses 05, 06, 07, 09, and 13  
Zone 02 has the following addressable devices assigned to it:  
• MMF-302 monitor module with addresses 02 and 03  
• CP350 smoke detectors with addresses 03 and 04  
• CMF-300 control modules with addresses 08, 09, and 10  
Zone 03 has the following addressable devices assigned to it:  
• SD350 smoke detectors with addresses 05, 06, and 07  
• MMF-302 control module with address 04  
• CMF-300 control modules with addresses 09, 11, and 12  
The example points out some of the key assignment features of the FACP. Addresses of detectors  
are not duplicated. Addresses of monitor and control modules are not duplicated. The control  
module with address 09 is assigned to three software zones (providing floor above and floor  
below). Be careful to properly plan the installation prior to installing any devices.  
1. CLIP or Classic Loop Interface Protocol devices (modules and detectors) can only have  
unique addresses of 1 to 99. Newer LiteSpeed devices (modules and detectors) can have  
unique addresses of 1 to 159 which means each zone can have up to 159 input and output  
devices assigned to it.  
178  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Correlations  
Software Zones  
Correlation of Input and Output Zones  
Input Devices  
Zones  
Output Devices  
SD350  
01  
CMF-300  
13  
SD350  
02  
CMF-300  
05  
ZONE  
01  
MMF-300  
01  
CMF-300  
06  
MMF-302  
02  
CMF-300  
07  
CMF-300  
09  
MMF-302  
03  
CMF-300  
08  
CP350  
03  
ZONE  
02  
CMF-300  
10  
CP300  
04  
SD350  
05  
CMF-300  
11  
SD350  
06  
ZONE  
03  
SD350  
07  
CMF-300  
12  
MMF-302  
04  
The zone correlations which are shown graphically above are also presented in Table A.1 on  
page 180 and Table A.2 on page 181.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Software Zones  
Correlations  
DETECTOR ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
1
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
SD350  
FIRST HALL  
ELEV. LOBBY  
2ND FLOOR  
ROOM 210  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
SD350  
CP350  
CP350  
SD350  
SD350  
SD350  
1
2
2
3
3
3
3RD FLOOR  
MEZZANINE  
MECH. ROOM  
Table A.1 Detector Programming Sheet Example  
180  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Correlations  
Software Zones  
MONITOR/CONTROL MODULE ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Zone  
Number  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
Address  
Device Type  
ADJ/NOUN  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
MMF-300  
MMF-302  
MMF-302  
MMF-302  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
CMF-300  
1
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
1, 2  
1, 2  
3
1
1
1
2
1, 2, 3  
2
3
3
1
Table A.2 Module Programming Sheet Example  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Software Zones  
Correlations  
DETECTOR ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
Table A.3 Blank Detector Programming Sheet - 1 of 2  
182  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Correlations  
Software Zones  
DETECTOR ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Number  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
Table A.4 Blank Detector Programming Sheet - 2 of 2  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Software Zones  
Correlations  
MONITOR/CONTROL MODULE ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Device  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Zone  
Number  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Number  
Type  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
Table A.5 Blank Module Programming Sheet - 1 of 2  
184  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Correlations  
Software Zones  
MONITOR/CONTROL MODULE ZONE ASSIGNMENT  
Device  
Device  
Type  
Zone  
Zone  
Number  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Address  
ADJ/NOUN  
Number  
Type  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
129  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
Table A.6 Blank Module Programming Sheet - 2 of 2  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix B: Default Programming  
The following table provides a list of the programming options and their factory default settings.  
Program Option  
Master Password  
Maintenance Password  
Detector Programming  
Detector Type  
Factory Default  
00000  
Program Option  
Factory Default  
NAC Enable  
Enabled  
11111  
NAC Silenceable  
Yes  
Not Installed  
Smoke-Photo  
Off  
NAC Type  
Bell  
NAC Sync Type  
System Sensor  
Detector Verification  
Detector Walktest  
Detector PAS  
NAC Autosilence  
0
Yes  
NAC Coding  
Steady  
Zone 000 only  
0
No  
NAC Zones  
Detector Presignal  
Detector Zone Assign.  
Detector Adj/Noun  
Module Programming  
Module Type  
No  
NAC Silence Inhibit  
Relay 1  
000 only  
none  
Alarm  
Trouble  
Supervisory  
No  
Relay 2  
Not Installed  
Monitor  
Yes  
Relay 3  
On Board DACT  
Module Walktest  
(not used)  
Annunciator Terminal Mode  
Annunciator ACS Mode  
UDACT  
No  
No  
Module Presignal  
Module Zone Assign.  
Module Adj/Noun  
Zone 0 Enable  
No  
No  
000 only  
none  
ACS Installed  
No  
Printer-PC  
No  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
.....................  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Monitor  
Style 4  
Printer Baud  
9600  
Off  
Zone 1 Enable  
Canadian Option  
Zone 2 Enable  
Waterflow Silenceable  
ANN-BUS Enabled  
Central Station Reporting  
AC Loss Delay  
No  
Zone 3 Enable  
No  
.........................through..........  
Zone 99 Enable  
Disabled  
2 Hours  
First Available  
By Point  
No  
Special Zones 97, 98 & 99  
Zones 0 - 99 Type  
Loop 1 & 2 Style  
Loop 1 & 2 Protocol  
Trouble Reminder  
Banner  
DACT Backup Reporting  
DACT Report Style  
ANN Enabled  
LiteSpeed  
Off  
ANN-BUS Modules Addr. 1 - 8  
ANN-S/PG Port  
None  
Parallel  
9600  
7
ANN-S/PG Baud  
Time Format  
12 Hr  
ANN-S/PG Data Bits  
ANN-S/PG Parity  
Hours Setting  
12  
Even  
1
Minutes Setting  
00  
ANN-S/PG Stop Bits  
ANN-S/PG Offline Timer  
ANN-S/PG Printer Supervision  
ANN-80 Piezo Enabled  
ANN-80 Lock Enabled  
ANN-80 Acknowledge Button Enabled  
ANN-80 Silence Button Enabled  
ANN-80 Reset Button Enabled  
ANN-80 Drill Button Enabled  
ANN-I/O Point/Zone  
ANN-I/O Range  
Second Settings  
AM-PM Setting  
00  
60  
AM  
No  
Month Setting  
01  
Yes  
Day Setting  
01  
Yes  
Year Setting  
00  
Yes  
PK-Plus Secret Code  
Trouble Call Limit  
Daylight Savings  
Month Start Daylight Savings  
Week Start Daylight Savings  
Month End Daylight Savings  
Week End Daylight  
Verification  
00000000  
Yes  
0
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
March  
Zone  
00-29  
2nd Week  
November  
ANN-I/O Active LEDs Only  
ANN-RLY Relay 1  
................through.......................  
ANN-RLY Relay 10  
ANN-LED Point/Zone  
1st Week  
Zone 1  
............  
Zone 10  
Zone  
No  
0
Ring Count  
PAS Timer  
0
Presignal Timer  
0
ANN-LED Alarms/ATS (Alarm, Trbl, Supv) ATS  
ANN-LED Range 0 - 9  
Waterflow Retard Timer  
0
186  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendix C: NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
The FACP has been designed for use in commercial, industrial and institutional applications and  
meets the requirements for service under the National Fire Protection Association (NFPA)  
Standards outlined in this Appendix. The minimum system components required for compliance  
with the appropriate NFPA standard are listed below:  
Fire Alarm Control Panel  
Contains the main control board, cabinet (backbox and door), main power supply transformer and  
power supply.  
Batteries  
Refer to “Power Supply Calculations” on page 174, for Standby Power Requirements.  
Initiating Devices  
Connected to one of the control panel's Initiating Device Circuits.  
Notification Appliances  
Connected to the control panel's Notification Appliance Circuits via a control module.  
The following additional equipment is needed for compliance with the NFPA 72 standards listed  
below:  
NFPA 72 NATIONAL FIRE ALARM STANDARDS FOR:  
NFPA 72 Central Station Service (Protected Premises Unit) or Remote Station  
Service  
411UDAC for connection to a compatible listed Central Station DACR or Protected Premises  
OR  
411UD may be installed as illustrated in Figure C.2, “FACP Connection to 411UD,” on page  
189.  
OR  
4XTMF Transmitter Module for connection to the RS82 Remote Station Receiver. See Figure  
C.4, “Remote Station Connection Using 4XTMF Module,” on page 191, for installation  
instructions for this unit.  
NFPA 72 Auxiliary Fire Alarm System  
4XTMF Transmitter Module for connection to a compatible listed Local Energy Municipal Box.  
This unit must be installed as illustrated in the section titled “4XTMF Transmitter Module  
Installation” on page 55 and as outlined in Figure C.3, “Municipal Box Connected to 4XTMF  
Transmitter Module,” on page 190.  
NFPA 72 Proprietary Fire Alarm System  
FACP Alarm, Trouble and Supervisory contacts connected to Transmitter(s). See Figure C.5,  
“Proprietary Protective Signaling System,” on page 192, for installation instructions for this unit.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
NFPA Signaling Systems for Central Station Service (Protected Premises  
Unit)/Remote Station  
The following figure illustrates an example of Central Station/Remote Station Reporting using a  
411UDAC. The relay contacts from the FACP may be used to trip any dialer UL listed for Central  
Station/Remote Station Services.  
Notes:  
1. Reference the 411UDAC Manual for additional information  
2. Program the 411UDAC for slave operation  
3. The FACP must be programmed for AC Loss Reporting Delay This prevents the transmission  
of a trouble on the loss of AC power  
Program the 411UDAC as follows:  
Channel 1 - Normally Open Contact  
Device (alarm)  
Channel 2 - Host Panel Trouble  
Channel 3 - Supervisory  
411UDAC Relay 2 Output (DACT Trouble)  
Channel 2/Zone 2  
Channel 1/Zone 1  
2.2K  
Monitor Module  
ELR resistor  
Channel 3/Zone 3  
ELR  
2.2K EOLR  
Note: The Monitor Module input,  
which is being used to monitor the  
411UDAC Relay Output  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10  
programmed for DACT Trouble  
(requires optional 411RK Relay Kit),  
must be programmed as ‘Trouble’ at  
the FACP. The 411UDAC must be  
programmed as a Slave  
Communicator (programming  
address 64 set to 2).  
411UDAC  
Monitor Module Circuit Input  
*If the SLC device does  
not match the one in this  
figure, refer to the SLC  
manual appendix, which  
contains wiring conversion  
charts for type V and type  
H modules.  
UL listed 2.2K ELRs (P/N 27070)  
TB1  
Monitor Module*  
SLC Loop  
AC wiring for  
411UDAC/FACP must  
be connected to the  
same branch circuit.  
123456  
123  
FACP  
Figure C.1 Central Station Service Using 411UDAC  
411UDAC  
FACP  
TB1-3  
TB1-1  
TB5-3  
TB5-2  
TB5-6  
TB5-4  
TB2-1  
Alarm  
TB2-2  
TB2-3  
Trouble  
TB2-4  
TB2-5  
Supervisory  
TB2-8  
Table C.1 411UDAC Connections to FACP  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
The following figure illustrates an example of Central Station/Remote Station Reporting using a  
411UD. The relay contacts from the FACP may be used to trip any dialer UL listed for Central  
Station/Remote Station Reporting Services.  
Note: The Monitor Module input, which is being used to monitor  
the 411UD Relay #2 Output (programmed for DACT Trouble),  
must be programmed as ‘Trouble’ at FACP.  
Channel1  
1
Channel 4 (2.2K ELR)  
2
Channel 2  
3
4
Channel 3  
5
6
Monitor Module ELR resistor  
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
Relay Output (DACT Trouble)  
6
7
8
9
411UD  
FACP  
J4 Not Installed  
Supervisory Relay  
Monitor Module Circuit Input  
FACP  
Trouble Relay  
*If the SLC device does  
not match the one in this  
figure, refer to the SLC  
manual appendix, which  
contains wiring conversion  
charts for type V and type  
H modules.  
24 VDC  
nonresettable  
power  
FACP  
Alarm Relay  
(2.2K ELRs  
P/N 27070)  
Monitor Module*  
SLC Loop  
+
-
1 2 3  
1 2 3 4 5 6  
FACP  
Figure C.2 FACP Connection to 411UD  
411UD  
FACP  
TB1-1  
TB1-3  
TB5-2  
TB5-3  
TB5-4  
TB5-6  
Alarm  
Trouble  
TB2-1  
TB2-2  
TB2-3  
TB2-4  
TB2-5  
TB2-6  
Supervisory  
Table C.2 411-UD Connections to FACP  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
NFPA 72 Auxiliary Fire Alarm System  
All connections are power-limited and supervised. This application is not suitable for separate  
transmission of sprinkler supervisory or trouble conditions.  
Notes:  
1. 3 ohms maximum loop resistance allowed for wiring from control panel to Municipal Box.  
2. Cut JP6 on the FACP main circuit board to supervise placement of 4XTMF module and circuit.  
3. Cut JP5 on the FACP main circuit board to enable FACP Supervisory relay.  
4. Refer to “4XTMF Transmitter Module Installation” on page 55 for detailed information.  
FIRE  
+
Municipal Box Circuit  
-
Gamewell Model M34-56  
Local Energy Municipal Box  
Polarities shown in alarm condition  
Nonpower-limited  
-
+
4XTMF  
Figure C.3 Municipal Box Connected to 4XTMF Transmitter Module  
190  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
NFPA 72 Remote Station Protective Signaling System  
Notes:  
1. Cut Jumper JP6 on the FACP main circuit board to supervise placement of the 4XTMF  
module.  
2. Refer to “4XTMF Transmitter Module Installation” on page 55 for detailed information.  
RS82 Remote Station Receiver UL listed.  
Refer to Fire•Lite Alarms, Inc., Instruction Manual for Remote  
Station Receiver Model RS82.  
Polarity Shown is  
Normal Standby  
+
-
+
-
Power-limited  
(Dummy load with a 4.7K, ¼ watt resistor  
when no connection is made)  
Cutting TBL Jumper allows the  
reverse polarity circuit to open with  
a system trouble condition if no  
alarm condition exists.  
4XTMF Transmitter Module  
Figure C.4 Remote Station Connection Using 4XTMF Module  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
NFPA 72 Proprietary Protective Signaling Systems  
FACP Addressable Fire Control Panel  
FACP Main Board  
Form-C Alarm contact programmed to  
activate on General Alarm.  
Form-C Trouble contact which will automat-  
ically activate on any Trouble condition.  
Form-C relay contact programmed to  
activate on Supervisory condition.  
Notes:  
1. Connection between the FACP and the  
transmitter are supervised by the transmitter.  
2. This FACP/Transmitter arrangement can be  
employed for NFPA 72 Proprietary Protective  
Signaling System.  
3. Potter Electric Model EFT-C has not been  
tested for UL 864 9th Edition and is for use in  
retrofit applications only.  
Figure C.5 Proprietary Protective Signaling System  
192  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Central Station/Remote Station Transmitter: Connection to FACP Dry Contacts  
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
C.1 Central Station/Remote Station Transmitter: Connection  
to FACP Dry Contacts  
The dry contacts of the FACP programmable relays can be used to trip a UL-864 Listed Central  
Station/Remote Station Transmitter. The FACP contacts must be supervised by the Central  
Station/Remote Station Transmitter module using End-of-Line Resistors (ELRs) with a value  
determined by the Transmitter manufacturer. Power is also provided by the Central Station/Remote  
Station Transmitter manufacturer. Refer to the Central Station/Remote Station Transmitter  
manufacturer’s manual for details.  
Typical Central Station/Remote Station Transmitter Module  
Typical Input Zone Triggers  
*Note: The Trouble Relay is a fail-  
safe relay. With power applied to  
the FACP and no troubles in the  
panel, the wiring should be  
connected to the NO and C contacts  
as indicated in the illustration.  
FACP Main Circuit Board  
Figure C.6 FACP Dry Contacts Connection to Central Station/Remote Station Transmitter  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
NFPA Standard-Specific Requirements  
MBT-1 Municipal Box Trip - Silenceable  
C.2 MBT-1 Municipal Box Trip - Silenceable  
The following figure illustrates the connection of the MBT-1 (Municipal Box Trip) between the  
FACP and a Local Energy Municipal Box. The use of an addressable control module programmed  
for General Alarm and Silenceable allows silencing of the Municipal Box without resetting the  
panel or box.  
Connect wires to two  
red terminals on box.  
Note: 10maximum loop  
resistance due to wiring from  
power supply to Municipal Box.  
Gamewell Model  
M34-56 Local Energy  
Municipal Box  
(All contacts shown in energized position)  
white wire  
MBT-1  
- To next device  
+ on SLC Loop  
Braided-shield/Drain Wire  
The CMF-300 must be  
programmed as Silenceable  
and General Alarm.  
brown wire  
black  
EOLR-1 Power  
Supervision Relay  
red  
Alarm polarity shown!  
-
+
CMF-300  
SLC Loop B+ -B  
Shield  
+
-
24 VDC, Nonresettable  
FACP  
194  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix D: FACP with Keltron  
The following figure illustrates the connections between the FACP and Keltron  
Receiver/Transmitter.  
CAUTION:  
POSSIBLE EQUIPMENT DAMAGE  
!
FOR REASONS OF WIRING DIAGRAM CLARITY, TERMINAL DESIGNATIONS OF KELTRON  
MODULES ARE NOT SHOWN IN ACTUAL ORDER. FOLLOW KELTRON MANUAL AND MODULE  
MARKINGS FOR EXACT TERMINAL LOCATIONS TO PREVENT SEVERE MODULE DAMAGE!  
IMPORTANT! All connections between the FACP and Keltron modules must be made within 20  
feet and enclosed within conduit or equivalently protected against mechanical injury.  
Keltron 95M3158 TTM-RPS  
1. Terminals 7 and 8: Remote station alarm/trouble inputs.  
2. Terminals 9 and 10: Sprinkler supervisory input.  
Tip  
Tip  
Ring  
Telephone Line  
Ring  
Earth  
Earth  
To Central/  
Remote  
Station  
UL Listed  
UL Listed  
8th Edition Only  
8th Edition Only  
To Power  
Supply  
*Note: For more  
information, refer to  
Keltron manual.  
Sprinkler  
Supervisory Signal  
Alarm/Trouble Signal  
24 VDC  
nonresettable power  
4XTMF Module  
Note: Cut TBL jumper on 4XTMF module to send  
alarm/trouble signal from the same pair or terminals.  
Fire Alarm Control Panel  
(terminal blocks are not shown in their actual  
positions in order to clarify wiring connections)  
Figure D.1 Wiring to Keltron Printer  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix E: Wire Requirements  
T-tapping of the SLC loop wiring is allowed for 2-wire (Style 4) configurations. The total  
resistance of any branch cannot exceed 40 ohms. The total wire length of all branches cannot  
exceed 10,000 feet (3,000 m).  
Connecting external system accessories to the FACP main circuits must be carefully considered to  
ensure proper operation. It is important to use the correct type of wire, wire gauge and wire run  
length for each FACP circuit. Reference the chart below to specify wire requirements and  
limitations for each FACP circuit.  
Note:  
1. If the SLC loop is to be run in conduit with Notification Appliance Circuits, the risk of  
encountering problems can be greatly reduced by exclusively employing electronic sounders  
instead of more electronically noisy notification appliances such as electromechanical bells or  
horns.  
2. If two SLC loops are to be installed in conduit, each loop must be installed in separate conduit.  
3. The SLC can be programmed to operate in LiteSpeed mode (factory default setting) for a  
quicker device response time. While shielded wire is not required in LiteSpeed mode, it is  
recommended that all SLC wiring be twisted-pair to minimize the effects of electrical  
interference. Use the following table to determine the specific wiring requirements for the  
SLC when unshielded wire is used:  
CIRCUIT CONNECTIONS  
WIRE REQUIREMENTS  
Recommended Max.  
Circuit Type  
Circuit Function  
Wire Type and Limitations  
Distance  
Wire Gauge and Compatible Brands  
Feet (meters)  
2
Connects to  
Twisted, shielded pair  
10,000 (3,000 m)  
12 AWG (3.25 mm ): Genesis 4410,  
Addressable Devices 40 ohms maximum per length  
Signal 98230, Belden 9583, WPW999  
14 AWG (2.00 mm ):Genesis 4408 & 4608  
2
of Style 6 and 7 loops. 40 ohms 8,000 (2,400 m)  
per branch maximum for Style 4  
Signal 98430, Belden 9581, WPW995  
2
CLIP MODE  
loops  
4,875 (1,450 m)  
16 AWG (1.30 mm ): Genesis 4406 & 4606  
Signal 98630, Belden 9575, WPW991  
Direct Burial Cable Isotec NP713110VNQ-S  
2
3,225 (980 m)  
18 AWG (0.75 mm ): Genesis 4402 & 4602  
Signal 98300, Belden 9574, WPW975  
Direct Burial Cable Isotec NP714110VNQ-S  
SLC loop  
(power-limited)  
2
Twisted, unshielded pair  
10,000 (3,000 m)  
12 AWG (3.25 mm ): Belden 5020UL &  
40 ohms maximum per length  
of Style 6 and 7 loops. 40 ohms 8,000 (2,400 m)  
per branch maximum for Style 4  
6020UL, Genesis WG-4315 & WG-4515  
14 AWG (2.00 mm ):Belden 5120UL &  
2
6120UL, Genesis WG-4313 & WG-4513  
2
loops  
4,875 (1,450 m)  
16 AWG (1.30 mm ): Belden 5220UL &  
LITESPEED MODE  
Connects to  
6220UL, Genesis WG-4311 & WG-4511  
18 AWG (0.75 mm ): Belden 5320UL &  
6320UL, Genesis WG-4306 & WG-4506  
2
3,225 (980 m)  
1
2
Untwisted, unshielded pair  
3,000 (900 m)  
12-18 AWG (3.25 - 0.75 mm ) using listed wire  
2
ACS-BUS  
Twisted pair with characteristic 6,000 (1,800 m)  
12 AWG (3.25 mm )  
(EIA-485)  
annunciator modules impedance of 120 ohms  
(power-limited)  
ANN-BUS  
(EIA-485)  
(Power-limited)  
Connects to  
annunciator modules  
Twisted pair  
6,000 (1,800 m)  
50 (15 m)  
requirements.  
2
EIA-232  
(power-limited)  
connects to remote  
PC computer  
Twisted, shielded pair  
18 AWG (0.75 mm ) minimum  
2
MMF-300 and  
MMF-301  
Initiating Device  
Circuit  
Maximum loop wire resistance 2,500 (760 m)  
is 40 ohms for the MMF-300  
12-18 AWG (3.25 - 0.75 mm )  
(power-limited)  
and 20 ohms for the MMF-301  
2
MMF-302  
(power-limited)  
Initiating Device  
Circuit  
No more than a 2.4 volt drop  
allowed at end of circuit.  
Maximum loop wire resistance  
is 25 ohms  
2,500 (760 m)  
12-18 AWG (3.25 - 0.75 mm )  
2
CMF-300  
Notification Appliance In alarm, no more than a 1.2  
Distance limitation set 12-18 AWG (3.25 - 0.75 mm )  
(power-limited)  
Circuit  
volt drop allowed at end of  
circuit  
by 1.2 volt maximum  
line drop  
Table E.1 FACP Wire Specifications  
1
When using untwisted, unshielded wire, full conduit is recommended for optimum EMI/RFI protection.  
196  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
NAC Wiring  
Wire Requirements  
E.1 NAC Wiring  
The following table lists NAC wiring requirements for the FACP.  
CLASS-B  
Max. allowable wire pair length  
(feet)  
CLASS-A  
Max. allowable wire pair length  
(feet)  
Max.  
allowable  
total loop  
resistance  
(ohms)  
NAC Load  
(Amps)  
AWG 12  
solid  
AWG 14  
solid  
AWG 16  
solid  
AWG 18  
solid  
AWG 12  
solid  
AWG 14  
solid  
AWG 16  
solid  
AWG 18  
solid  
0.25  
0.5  
0.75  
1
12.72  
6.36  
4.24  
3.18  
2.54  
2.12  
1.82  
1.59  
1.41  
1.27  
3295  
1648  
1098  
824  
2072  
1036  
691  
518  
414  
345  
296  
259  
230  
207  
1301  
650  
434  
325  
260  
217  
186  
163  
145  
130  
819  
409  
273  
205  
164  
136  
117  
102  
91  
1648  
824  
549  
412  
330  
275  
235  
206  
183  
165  
1036  
518  
345  
259  
207  
173  
148  
129  
115  
104  
650  
325  
217  
163  
130  
108  
93  
409  
205  
136  
102  
82  
1.25  
1.5  
1.75  
2
659  
549  
68  
471  
58  
412  
81  
511  
45  
2.25  
2.5  
366  
72  
330  
82  
65  
41  
Table E.2 NAC Wiring Requirements for FACP  
Notes:  
1. Calculations are based on Direct-Current Resistance data for uncoated copper wire, per  
National Electrical Code (2005 Edition) Table 8, Conductor Properties.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix F: HVAC Control  
The FACP can be programmed to shut down a building’s HVAC fans in the event of a fire. The  
fans cannot be restarted until the fire alarm condition has been cleared and the FACP has been reset  
to a normal (non-alarm) condition.  
IMPORTANT! This HVAC feature is not to be used for smoke control. It is only designed to shut  
down fans during a fire alarm condition.  
F.1 Control Module Operation  
F.1.1 HVAC SHUTDN  
The HVAC SHUTDN type code can be assigned to any addressable control relay module for the  
purpose of shutting down HVAC fans during a fire alarm condition. Devices connected to a  
module with this type code are unsupervised. To program this feature in the FACP:  
Program the HVAC SHUTDN type code to the control module which will be used to shut  
down the fans (refer to Type under the section titled “Edit Module Screen for Control  
Program the control module to a software zone and program alarm input devices which, when  
activated are to cause fan shutdown, to the same software zone (refer to Zone Assignment  
Monitor the control module using an addressable monitor module programmed for Trouble  
Monitor. The monitor module label should be programmed to indicate HVAC SHUTDOWN.  
When the control module is active (HVAC SHUTDN), the monitor module will indicate a  
trouble condition at the FACP and the display should indicate the HVAC is shut down.  
Once activated, the HVAC SHUTDN control module remains activated, even if the FACP is  
silenced or reset. After the alarm condition on the FACP has been cleared and the panel reset, the  
HVAC SHUTDN control module remains activated and the fans remain off. The monitor module  
programmed for Trouble Monitor which is being used to supervise the control module, will indicate  
a trouble condition at the control panel and the LCD should display that the HVAC is shut down.  
The fans can only be restarted when the HVAC SHUTDN control module is deactivated by the  
HVAC RESTART module.  
F.2 Monitor Module Operation  
F.2.1 HVAC RESTART  
The HVAC RESTART type code can be assigned to any addressable monitor module for the  
purpose of resetting (deactivating) the HVAC SHUTDN control module and turning the fans back  
on. The HVAC RESTART monitor module acts globally throughout the FACP system and  
therefore is not programmed to a particular software zone. To program this feature in the FACP:  
Program the HVAC RESTART type code to the monitor module which will be used to  
deactivate the HVAC SHUTDN control module and restart the fans (refer to Type Monitor  
The HVAC RESTART monitor module does not latch when activated. Pressing a switch connected  
to the monitor module will deactivate the HVAC SHUTDN control relay module only if there are  
no alarm conditions. The HVAC SHUTDN control relay module can be deactivated if trouble  
conditions exist on the FACP.  
198  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Monitor Module Operation  
HVAC Control  
F.2.2 HVAC OVRRIDE  
The HVAC OVRRIDE type code can be assigned to any addressable monitor module for the  
purpose of overriding or preventing the HVAC SHUTDN control modules from activating. The  
HVAC OVRRIDE monitor module acts globally throughout the FACP system and therefore is not  
programmed to a particular software zone. To program this feature in the FACP:  
Program the HVAC OVRRIDE type code to the monitor module which will be used to  
override the HVAC SHUTDN control module and prevent the fans from turning off (refer to  
The HVAC OVRRIDE monitor module does not latch when activated. Activating a switch  
connected to the monitor module will override all HVAC SHUTDN control relay modules in the  
system, preventing the HVAC SHUTDN modules from activating and causing the FACP LCD to  
display an active HVAC OVRRIDE module and turn on the Supervisory LED. Releasing the  
switch will allow the HVAC SHUTDN control relay modules to activate with subsequent alarms,  
turning off the fans.  
As an example, pressing the HVAC OVRRIDE switch with no alarms in the system will prevent the  
fans from being turned off when an alarm does occur. As long as the switch is activated, the fans  
will not shutdown for any alarms. If the system is still in alarm when the switch is released, the  
fans will not shutdown unless another alarm occurs after the switch is released.  
Important! If an alarm exists in the system and HVAC Shutdown has already occurred, HVAC  
OVRRIDE will have no effect on the HVAC SHUTDN control relay modules. HVAC OVRRIDE  
will prevent HVAC Shutdown from occurring only if it is initiated prior to an alarm condition.  
NOTE: Activation of the HVAC OVRRIDE module causes a supervisory event that will be  
communicated to the Central Station if enabled.  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix G: Canadian Application  
The MS-9600LSC is supplied with the DP-9692 Dress Panel.  
When installing and programming the FACP, the Canadian Option must be set to ON prior to  
any other panel programming (refer to “Canadian Option” on page 113 of the Programming  
Section of this manual).  
ACS Series annunciators are not compatible for Canadian applications.  
The LCD-80FC annunciator can be used for optional ancillary annunciation.  
The ANN-LED annunciator must be installed in the same room as the FACP. All wiring  
between the FACP and ANN-LED must be in metal conduit no longer than 20 feet.  
The installer must write in the Date of Final Assembly on the Master Marking and Warranty  
Label located on the FACP backbox door.  
To comply with CAN/ULC - S559-04, the DACT-UD2 and 4XTMF must both be utilized.  
ANN-LED annunciator must  
be in same room as FACP  
metal conduit  
(max. 20 ft.)  
ANN-LED Annunciator  
FACP  
Figure G.1 FACP Minimum Configuration - Single ANN-LED Annunciator  
metal conduit  
(max. 20 ft.)  
ANN-LED annunciators must  
be in same room as FACP  
FACP  
ANN-LED Annunciators  
Figure G.2 FACP Maximum Configuration - Eight ANN-LED Annunciators  
200  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Index  
ANN-RLY Annunciator Module 36  
ANN-SB80KIT Mounting Kit 28  
annunciator 40  
Numerics  
4XTMF module 190, 191  
coil resistance 55  
ACM 14, 120  
ACM-8RF 14  
current 55  
installation 55  
installation steps 56  
see also Transmitter Module 15, 21  
voltage 55  
graphic, see also LDM Series 14, 40  
annunciator addressing 120  
annunciator, remote  
see also LCD-80F 40  
Auto Silence  
NAC 110  
A
Automatic Test Operation 156  
Autoprogramming 15, 62, 66  
Autosilence 14, 159  
auxiliary DC power 47  
AC Branch Circuit  
calculations 174  
AC Loss Delay 106  
AC Power 46  
current 15  
current, maximum 46  
voltage 15  
wiring 15, 46  
B
backbox 19  
see also cabinet 45  
Banner 100  
Banner setting 101  
battery 19  
Acknowledge/Step 18, 150  
ACM LED annunciator 60  
ACM Series  
see also annunciator 40  
ACM-16ATF Annunciator 40  
ACM-32AF Annunciator 40  
ACM-8RF 14  
cable connection 46  
charger 18, 22  
charger capacity 15  
charger, disable 15  
charger, external 22  
Charging Circuit 15  
see also secondary power 15, 46  
battery box 22  
contact rating 59  
see also Relay Control Module 59  
ACS LED annunciator 14  
add Detector 67  
add Module 78  
address range 20  
baud rate 134  
BB-55F  
addressable 13  
see also battery box 20, 22  
addressable detectors  
see also detectors 15  
addressable modules 20  
see also modules 15  
addressing  
C
cabinet 19  
dimensions 44, 45  
mounting 42  
annunciators 120  
Calculate System Current Draw 175  
Calculating the Battery Size 177  
Canadian Option 100, 113  
Central Station/Remote Station Reporting 189  
CHG-120F  
see also device addressing 100  
see also module or detector addressing 20  
Adjective  
control module 92  
monitor module 85  
multiple entries 77  
Adjective list 75  
see also battery charger 22  
see also remote battery charger 15  
CHG-75  
AEM-16ATF Annunciator 40  
AEM-32AF Annunciator 40  
Alarm 153  
see also battery charger 22  
see also remote battery charger 15  
Class A 47  
Alarm Silence 18, 150  
alarm verification 14, 72, 157, 159  
Class B 47  
NAC wiring 49  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
D–E  
Index  
Classic Loop Interface Protocol 100  
CLIP Mode  
Detector  
add 67  
see also Classic Loop Interface Protocol  
adding description 74  
delete 68  
Clock Format 104  
Coded Operation 157  
Coding  
edit 69  
enable/disable 71  
screen display 70  
type 71  
NAC 110  
coding  
verification 72  
two stage operation 111  
control buttons 150  
control module 20  
description display 94  
display 88  
detector data 157, 171, 172  
acceptable range 171  
printout 171  
Detector Programming 67  
device addressing 100  
Digital Alarm Communicator/Transmitter  
see also DACT-UD2 21  
dimensions  
edit 88  
enable/disable 89  
noun 93  
noun/adjective 91, 92  
silenceable 90  
cabinet 44  
DIRTY1 172  
type 89  
DIRTY2 172  
type codes 90  
Disable 96  
Correlations 178  
current  
Disable Point  
Maintenance Level 139  
dress panel 19, 22  
drift compensation 14, 172  
definition 172  
AC Power 46  
availability 17  
maximum 17  
Drill 18, 150  
D
E
DACT 134  
earth ground 46  
DACT-UD2 15  
edit  
functions 52  
installation 52  
control module 88  
detector 69  
option module installation 52, 53  
phone lines 54  
see also Digital Alarm Communicator/  
Transmitter 21  
detector screens 70  
module, monitor 79  
EIA-232 59  
for PC/Printer connection 16  
see also Printer/PC interface 14  
EIA-485  
for ACS annunciators 16  
for LCD-80F 16  
Enable 95  
data  
see also detector data and sensitivity 157  
values 14  
Data Entry  
via computer keyboard 61  
via keypad 61  
Enable/Disable  
Date setting 103  
Daylight Savings Time 104  
DC power  
control module 89  
detector 71  
module, monitor 81  
End-of-Line Resistor Assembly 20  
Enter key 64  
nonresettable 47  
resettable 47  
see also auxiliary DC power 47  
Default Programming 186  
Delete Detector 68  
Delete Module 79  
Description  
Erase History 115  
exiting  
programming 63, 64  
Read Status 63, 64  
Expander Module 57  
see also SLC-2 21  
control module 94  
detector label 77  
monitor module 87  
202  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
F–N  
Maintenance 151  
see also Indicators 17  
Supervisory 151  
F
FACP  
see also Fire Alarm Control Panel 13  
Trouble 151  
Features 13  
LED annunciator 40  
Local Energy Municipal Box Service 55  
Local Programming 62  
Loop Setup 99  
Fire Alarm Control Panel  
see also FACP 13  
Form-C relay 19, 47, 59  
G
M
general alarm zone 84  
see also zone Z00 74  
ground fault 59  
main circuit, mounting 42  
Maintenance Alert 14, 156  
levels 172  
maintenance alert 172  
Maintenance Program Level 2 63, 138  
Manual programming 62  
Master Program Level 1 63, 65  
Medical Alert 156  
Mode key 64  
H
Hazard Condition 155  
History 115  
erase 115  
Maintenance Level 140  
view events 115  
Module  
History file 14  
add 78  
HVAC Control 198  
HVAC OVRRIDE 199  
HVAC RESTART 198  
HVAC SHUTDN 198  
addressing 20  
delete 79  
edit monitor 79  
enable/disable 81  
see also addressable modules 20  
Module Programming 78  
Monitor module 20  
adjective 85  
I
Indicators 17  
Installation 42  
intelligent 13  
Inventory 13  
INVREP 172  
enable/disable 81  
noun 86  
noun/adjective 84  
type 82  
type action 83  
K
Type list 82  
type selection 83  
Mounting  
Key Panel 18  
function keys 18  
cabinet 42  
service/program keys 18  
keyboard and keypad 61  
Keypad/Display  
main circuit board 42  
municipal box transmitter  
see also 4XTMF module 55  
removal and installation 51  
N
L
NAC 15, 19, 107, 157  
Auto Silence 110  
coded 157  
lamp test 18  
LCD display 14, 17  
LCD-80F annunciator 14, 40  
LDM Series annunciator 40  
LED  
coding 110  
current 16  
End-of-Line Resistor 16  
power 14  
AC Power 150  
see also Notification Appliance Circuit 14,  
silence inhibit 112  
Alarm Silenced 151  
Battery 151  
Disabled 151  
silenceable 109  
Fire Alarm 150  
Style configuration 48  
Style Y wiring diagram 49  
Ground 151  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
O–P  
Index  
synchronized 157  
Output Circuits 18  
voltage drop 15  
voltage, operating 15  
wiring Style 47  
P
PAS 72, 96, 158  
NAC enable/disable 108  
NAC options 100  
NAC type 109  
see also Positive Alarm Sequence 14, 72  
PAS BYPASS 159  
PAS timer 105  
Password 15, 63  
change 135  
Maintenance Level 2 64, 138  
Master Level 1 64  
PC (personal computer)  
configuration 59  
connection 58  
ground fault 59  
Phone Line 2  
supervision 169  
phone lines  
DACT installation 54  
Piezo  
NACKEY card 48  
N-ELR Mounting Plate 21  
NFPA 72 Auxiliary Fire Alarm System 187, 190  
NFPA 72 Central Station Service (Protected  
NFPA 72 Proprietary Fire Alarm System 187  
NFPA 72 Proprietary Protective Signaling Sys-  
tems 192  
NFPA 72 Remote Station Protective Signaling  
System 191  
NFPA Battery Requirements 177  
NFPA Signaling Systems for Central Station Ser-  
vice (Protected Premises Unit)/Remote Station  
see also sounder 18  
Point Program 67  
Positive Alarm Sequence 72, 158  
see also PAS 14  
power  
NFPA Standard 187  
Nonresettable Power 18, 47  
current 16, 47  
nonsilenceable  
waterflow 114, 148  
NAC 14  
nonresettable 16  
resettable 89  
nonsilenceable waterflow 98  
normal display 62, 151  
see also NAC 14, 47  
resettable smoke 16  
power supply calculations 174  
power-limited  
relay connections 47  
Power-up  
first time 63  
Pre-signal 14, 73, 96  
function 158  
Noun  
monitor module 86  
multiple entries 77  
Noun list 76  
Noun/Adjective 74, 76  
control module 91  
monitor module 84  
selection 84  
primary power  
see also AC Power 46  
printer  
O
Operating Instructions 150  
Operation  
alarm 153  
disable/enable 156  
hazard condition 155  
medical alert 156  
NAC 157  
baud rate 134  
configuration 59  
connection 58  
ground fault 59  
setup 59  
normal 151  
process monitor 155  
programmed zone 156  
supervisory 154  
trouble 152  
Printer/PC interface 14  
Process Monitor 155  
PROCMON AR 113  
Program  
waterflow 156  
check 137  
Option Modules 21, 51, 117  
annunciators/UDACT 118  
Printer/PC 134  
check correlations 137  
clear 136  
Program Check  
Options 13  
Maintenance Level 141  
204  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
R–S  
program keys  
see also Key Panel 18  
Programming 61, 62  
autoprogramming 62  
exiting 63  
Reset 18, 150  
Resettable Power 18, 47, 89  
current 47  
see also Smoke Detector Power 16  
factory default 186  
Level 1 63  
Level 2 63  
manual 62  
Master Level 1 65  
S
Secondary Power Requirements 177  
sensitivity 157, 172  
see also smoke detector sensitivity 157  
Signal rate 14  
modules 78  
Signaling Line Circuit  
see also SLC 15  
Silence Inhibit 14, 112, 159  
silenceable  
off-line computer 62  
via computer keyboard 61  
via panel keypad 61  
Programming Levels 63  
Programming Screens 63  
Programming Sheet 180, 181, 182, 183, 185  
Programming Utility  
see also PS-Tools 21  
PRT/PK-CABLE  
control module 90  
NAC 109  
waterflow 98, 100, 114  
Silenceable Alarm Relay 113  
silenceable circuits  
synchronized signals 109  
Silenceable waterflow 148  
SLC 13, 15, 18  
for PC/Printer connection 59  
current 15  
reference manual 15  
resistance 15  
see also Signaling Line Circuit 13  
Style 18  
R
Read Status 62, 161  
annunciators 167, 169  
exiting 63  
history 167  
voltage 15  
NAC 166  
power 164  
Print 171  
printer/PC 170  
wiring length 15  
SLC Loop Protocol 100  
SLC loop selection 67  
SLC Style 99  
program check 167  
relay 166  
SLC-2 57  
installation 57  
system point 162  
Time-Date 173  
timers 165  
wiring 58  
SLC-2 Expander Module 21  
smoke detector  
trouble reminder 165  
zones 163  
Real-Time Clock 157  
Recall/Increment Function 77, 87, 94  
Relay 16, 19, 47, 112  
connections 47  
chamber reading 171  
data 157, 171  
sensitivity 157  
Smoke Detector Power  
current 16  
Software Zones 14, 178  
sounder 18  
contact rating 16, 19, 47  
fixed 47  
Form-C 16, 112  
programmable 14, 19, 47  
programming 113  
selections 113  
Specifications 15  
strobe synchronization 14  
Style 13  
Style Y 47  
trouble 14, 19, 47  
Relay Control Module  
see also ACM-8RF 59  
Relay options 100  
Remote Programming 62  
Remote Station Service 56  
remote switch functions 14  
NAC wiring 49  
NC configuration 48  
Style Z 47  
NAC configuration 48  
wiring 49  
subscreen 63  
supervise  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T–Z  
Index  
Phone Line 2 169  
Supervisory 154  
measurements 164  
ranges 164  
SUPERVISORY AR 113  
sync  
W
programming 108  
Walktest 14, 72, 90, 116  
audible 116  
see also synchronization 112  
synchronization 157, 166  
by manufacturer 112  
programming 112  
see also strobe synchronization 14  
synchronized 157  
Synchronized Signals 157  
and silenceable circuits 109  
System  
Maintenance Level 143  
System Point 162  
Maintenance Level 142  
operation 160  
selection 84  
silent 116  
waterflow  
nonsilenceable 98, 114, 148  
silenceable 98, 100, 114, 148  
Waterflow Delay timer 105, 106  
Waterflow Retard Timer 159  
Wire Requirements 196  
wiring  
System Setup 100  
AC Power 46  
earth ground 46  
NAC Style Y 49  
NAC Style Z 49  
SLC-2 58  
T
Time and Date  
Maintenance Level 143  
Time setting 103  
Time-Date setting 100, 103  
Timers 100  
wiring Style 13  
Transmitter Module 55  
see also 4XTMF module 21  
TR-CE trim ring 22  
Trouble 152  
trouble display 152  
trouble relay 14  
Trouble Reminder 100, 159, 165  
trouble responses 152  
Two Stage 96  
two stage operation 111  
Type  
Z
Z00 74, 84  
Z97  
PAS zone 73  
Z98 73  
Zone 97 96  
Zone 98 96  
Zone Assignment 73, 84, 112  
control module 90  
Zone Setup 95  
Maintenance Level 144  
zone type 98, 147  
list 98, 148  
Zone Z97 73  
Zone Z98  
control module 89  
detector 71  
monitor module 82  
NAC 109  
type code  
pre-signal zone 73  
Zones 163, 178  
see also software zones 14  
Zones Disabled 97, 147  
Zones Enabled 97, 146  
Zones Installed 97, 146  
zones per device 73  
control module 90  
supervision 157  
verification 14  
U
UL power-limited wiring requirements  
see also power-limited and nonpower-lim-  
ited 47  
V
Verification  
detector 72  
Verify Loops 114  
View Events 115  
voltage  
206  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manufacturer Warranties and Limitation of Liability  
Manufacturer Warranties. Subject to the limitations set forth herein,  
Manufacturer warrants that the Products manufactured by it in its  
Northford, Connecticut facility and sold by it to its authorized  
Distributors shall be free, under normal use and service, from defects  
in material and workmanship for a period of thirty six months (36)  
months from the date of manufacture (effective Jan. 1, 2009). The  
Products manufactured and sold by Manufacturer are date stamped at  
the time of production. Manufacturer does not warrant Products that  
are not manufactured by it in its Northford, Connecticut facility but  
assigns to its Distributor, to the extent possible, any warranty offered  
by the manufacturer of such product. This warranty shall be void if a  
Product is altered, serviced or repaired by anyone other than  
Manufacturer or its authorized Distributors. This warranty shall also  
be void if there is a failure to maintain the Products and the systems in  
which they operate in proper working conditions.  
MANUFACTURER MAKES NO FURTHER WARRANTIES, AND  
DISCLAIMS ANY AND ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EITHER  
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCTS,  
TRADEMARKS, PROGRAMS AND SERVICES RENDERED BY  
MANUFACTURER  
INCLUDING  
WITHOUT  
LIMITATION,  
INFRINGEMENT, TITLE, MERCHANTABILITY, OR FITNESS FOR  
ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE. MANUFACTURER SHALL NOT BE  
LIABLE FOR ANY PERSONAL INJURY OR DEATH WHICH MAY  
ARISE IN THE COURSE OF, OR AS A RESULT OF, PERSONAL,  
COMMERCIAL OR INDUSTRIAL USES OF ITS PRODUCTS.  
This document constitutes the only warranty made by Manufacturer  
with respect to its products and replaces all previous warranties and is  
the only warranty made by Manufacturer. No increase or alteration,  
written or verbal, of the obligation of this warranty is authorized.  
Manufacturer does not represent that its products will prevent any loss  
by fire or otherwise.  
Warranty Claims.  
Manufacturer shall replace or repair, at  
Manufacturer's discretion, each part returned by its authorized  
Distributor and acknowledged by Manufacturer to be defective,  
provided that such part shall have been returned to Manufacturer with  
all charges prepaid and the authorized Distributor has completed  
Manufacturer's Return Material Authorization form. The replacement  
part shall come from Manufacturer's stock and may be new or  
refurbished. THE FOREGOING IS DISTRIBUTOR'S SOLE AND  
EXCLUSIVE REMEDY IN THE EVENT OF A WARRANTY CLAIM.  
Warn-HL-08-2009.fm  
MS-9600LS Series Manual — P/N 52646:B2 2/12/2010  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
World Headquarters  
1 Firelite Place  
Northford, CT 06472-1653 USA  
203-484-7161  
fax 203-484-7118  
www.firelite.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Graco Coffeemaker TI12743a User Manual
Groupe SEB USA T FAL Toaster Neftis User Manual
GTO Safety Gate RB923 rev User Manual
Haier Washer Dryer HWM65 113S User Manual
HANNspree Flat Panel Television 62 01000016G000 User Manual
Harbor Freight Tools Paint Sprayer 93974 User Manual
Harbor Freight Tools Water Pump 68328 User Manual
Hotpoint Dishwasher HDA850G User Manual
HP Hewlett Packard Computer Monitor D8911 User Manual
HP Hewlett Packard Projector xp8000 series User Manual